* uintp.adb (Num_Bits): Handle Uint_Int_First specially.
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blob568a3804f502f3afbf4965c18ace59bc79353971
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
8 This file is part of GCC.
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
23 02110-1301, USA. */
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "coretypes.h"
40 #include "tm.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "version.h"
43 #include "flags.h"
44 #include "real.h"
45 #include "rtl.h"
46 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
47 #include "regs.h"
48 #include "insn-config.h"
49 #include "reload.h"
50 #include "function.h"
51 #include "output.h"
52 #include "expr.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "except.h"
55 #include "dwarf2.h"
56 #include "dwarf2out.h"
57 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
58 #include "toplev.h"
59 #include "varray.h"
60 #include "ggc.h"
61 #include "md5.h"
62 #include "tm_p.h"
63 #include "diagnostic.h"
64 #include "debug.h"
65 #include "target.h"
66 #include "langhooks.h"
67 #include "hashtab.h"
68 #include "cgraph.h"
69 #include "input.h"
71 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
72 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
73 #endif
75 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
76 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
77 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
78 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
79 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
80 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
81 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
82 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
83 CIE = Common Information Entry
84 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
85 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
86 FDE = Frame Description Entry
87 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
88 how to restore registers
90 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
91 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
93 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
94 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
95 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
96 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
97 # else
98 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
99 # endif
100 #endif
102 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
103 translation unit. */
106 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
108 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
109 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
110 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
111 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
112 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
113 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
114 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
115 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
116 && (flag_unwind_tables
117 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
118 #endif
122 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
123 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
124 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
125 #endif
127 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
128 must be kept around forever. */
129 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
131 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
132 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
133 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
134 it. */
135 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
137 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
138 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
139 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
140 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
141 define type declaration DIE's. */
142 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
144 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
145 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
146 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
147 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
148 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
149 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
150 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
151 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
152 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
153 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
155 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
156 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
157 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
158 #endif
160 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
161 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
162 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
164 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
165 Information instructions. The register number, offset
166 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
167 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
169 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
170 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
171 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
172 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
173 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
174 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
177 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
179 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
180 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
181 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
182 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
184 dw_cfi_oprnd;
186 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
188 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
189 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
190 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
191 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
192 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
193 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
195 dw_cfi_node;
197 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
198 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
199 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
200 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
201 of this structure. */
202 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
204 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
205 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
206 unsigned int reg;
207 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
208 } dw_cfa_location;
210 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
211 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
212 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
213 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
214 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
216 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
218 tree decl;
219 const char *dw_fde_begin;
220 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
221 const char *dw_fde_end;
222 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
223 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
224 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
225 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
226 bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
227 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
228 unsigned funcdef_number;
229 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
230 unsigned nothrow : 1;
231 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
233 dw_fde_node;
235 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
236 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
238 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
239 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
240 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
241 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
242 pointers. */
243 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
244 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
245 #endif
247 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
248 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
249 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
250 as PTR_SIZE. */
252 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
253 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
254 #endif
256 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
257 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
258 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
259 bytes.
261 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
262 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
264 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
265 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
266 #endif
268 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
270 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
271 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
272 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
274 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
275 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
276 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
277 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
278 #else
279 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
280 #endif
281 #endif
283 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
284 information for each routine. */
285 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
287 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
288 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
290 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
291 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
293 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
294 fde_table. */
295 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
297 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
298 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
300 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
301 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
302 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
303 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
304 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
305 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
306 #endif
308 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
310 const char *str;
311 unsigned int refcount;
312 unsigned int form;
313 char *label;
316 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
318 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
319 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
321 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
323 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
325 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
326 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
327 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
328 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
329 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
330 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
331 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
332 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
333 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
334 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
335 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
336 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
337 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
338 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
339 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
340 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
342 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
343 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
344 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
345 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
346 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
347 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
348 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
350 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
351 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
352 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
353 #endif
355 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
356 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
357 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
359 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
360 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
361 #endif
363 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
364 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
365 #endif
367 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
368 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
369 #endif
371 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
372 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
373 #endif
374 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
375 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
376 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
377 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
378 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
379 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
380 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
381 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
382 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
383 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
385 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
386 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
387 registers. */
388 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
389 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
390 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
391 #else
392 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
393 #endif
394 #endif
396 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
397 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
398 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
399 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
400 #endif
402 /* Hook used by __throw. */
405 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
407 return GEN_INT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
410 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
411 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
413 static inline char *
414 stripattributes (const char *s)
416 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
417 char *p = stripped;
419 *p++ = '*';
421 while (*s && *s != ',')
422 *p++ = *s++;
424 *p = '\0';
425 return stripped;
428 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
430 void
431 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
433 int i;
434 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
435 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
436 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
437 bool wrote_return_column = false;
439 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
440 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
442 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
443 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
444 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
446 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
447 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
448 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
450 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
451 continue;
452 wrote_return_column = true;
454 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
455 if (offset < 0)
456 continue;
458 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
459 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
462 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
463 gcc_assert (wrote_return_column);
464 i = DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
465 wrote_return_column = false;
466 #else
467 i = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
468 #endif
470 if (! wrote_return_column)
472 enum machine_mode save_mode = Pmode;
473 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = i * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
474 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
475 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
479 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
481 static const char *
482 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
484 switch (cfi_opc)
486 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
487 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
488 case DW_CFA_offset:
489 return "DW_CFA_offset";
490 case DW_CFA_restore:
491 return "DW_CFA_restore";
492 case DW_CFA_nop:
493 return "DW_CFA_nop";
494 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
495 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
496 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
497 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
498 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
499 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
500 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
501 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
502 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
503 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
504 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
505 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
506 case DW_CFA_undefined:
507 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
508 case DW_CFA_same_value:
509 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
510 case DW_CFA_register:
511 return "DW_CFA_register";
512 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
513 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
514 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
515 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
516 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
517 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
518 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
519 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
520 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
521 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
523 /* DWARF 3 */
524 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
525 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
526 case DW_CFA_expression:
527 return "DW_CFA_expression";
528 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
529 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
530 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
531 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
532 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
533 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
535 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
536 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
537 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
539 /* GNU extensions */
540 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
541 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
542 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
543 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
544 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
545 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
547 default:
548 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
552 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
554 static inline dw_cfi_ref
555 new_cfi (void)
557 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
559 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
560 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
561 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
563 return cfi;
566 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
568 static inline void
569 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
571 dw_cfi_ref *p;
573 /* Find the end of the chain. */
574 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
577 *p = cfi;
580 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
582 char *
583 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
585 static char label[20];
587 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
588 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
589 return label;
592 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
593 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
595 static void
596 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
598 if (label)
600 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
602 if (*label == 0)
603 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
605 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
606 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
608 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
610 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label = xstrdup (label);
612 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
613 xcfi = new_cfi ();
614 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
615 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
616 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
619 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
622 else
623 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
626 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
628 static void
629 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
631 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
633 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
634 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
635 break;
636 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
637 loc->offset
638 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
639 break;
640 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
641 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
642 break;
643 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
644 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
645 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
646 break;
647 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
648 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
649 loc->offset
650 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
651 break;
652 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
653 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
654 break;
655 default:
656 break;
660 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
662 static void
663 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
665 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
667 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
668 loc->offset = 0;
669 loc->indirect = 0;
670 loc->base_offset = 0;
672 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
673 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
675 if (fde_table_in_use)
677 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
678 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
679 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
683 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
684 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
686 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
687 from the CFA. */
688 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
690 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
691 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
693 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
694 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
696 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
697 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
698 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
700 void
701 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
703 dw_cfa_location loc;
704 loc.indirect = 0;
705 loc.base_offset = 0;
706 loc.reg = reg;
707 loc.offset = offset;
708 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
711 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
713 static bool
714 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
716 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
717 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
718 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
719 && (loc1->indirect == 0
720 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
723 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
724 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
726 static void
727 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
729 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
730 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
732 cfa = *loc_p;
733 loc = *loc_p;
735 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
736 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
738 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
739 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
741 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
742 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
743 return;
745 cfi = new_cfi ();
747 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
749 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
750 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. */
751 if (loc.offset < 0)
753 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
754 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
756 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
757 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
759 else
761 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
762 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
766 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
767 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
768 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
769 && !loc.indirect)
771 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
772 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
773 offset has not changed. */
774 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
775 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
777 #endif
779 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
781 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
782 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
783 the specified offset. */
784 if (loc.offset < 0)
786 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
787 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
789 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
790 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
791 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
793 else
795 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
796 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
797 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
800 else
802 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
803 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
804 register-offset pair is available. */
805 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
807 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
808 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
809 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
812 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
815 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
816 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
817 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
818 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
820 static void
821 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
823 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
825 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
827 if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
829 if (reg & ~0x3f)
830 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
831 the long form. */
832 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
833 else
834 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
836 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
838 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
839 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
840 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
841 description. */
842 HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
844 gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
846 #endif
847 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
848 if (offset < 0)
849 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
851 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
853 else if (sreg == reg)
854 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
855 else
857 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
858 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
861 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
864 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
865 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
866 from the previous frame's window save area.
868 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
869 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
871 void
872 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
874 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
876 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
877 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
880 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
881 pushed onto the stack. */
883 void
884 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
886 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
888 if (size == old_args_size)
889 return;
891 old_args_size = size;
893 cfi = new_cfi ();
894 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
895 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
896 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
899 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
900 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
902 void
903 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
905 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
908 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
909 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
911 void
912 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
914 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
917 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
918 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
920 void
921 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
923 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
926 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
927 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
929 static void
930 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
932 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
933 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
935 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
937 case REG:
938 /* RA is in a register. */
939 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
940 break;
942 case MEM:
943 /* RA is on the stack. */
944 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
945 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
947 case REG:
948 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
949 offset = 0;
950 break;
952 case PLUS:
953 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
954 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
955 break;
957 case MINUS:
958 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
959 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
960 break;
962 default:
963 gcc_unreachable ();
966 break;
968 case PLUS:
969 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
970 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
971 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
972 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
973 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
974 return;
976 default:
977 gcc_unreachable ();
980 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
981 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
984 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
985 contains. */
987 static HOST_WIDE_INT
988 stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
990 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
991 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
992 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
993 enum rtx_code code;
995 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
997 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
998 code = GET_CODE (src);
999 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1000 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1001 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1002 return 0;
1004 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1005 if (code == PLUS)
1006 offset = -offset;
1008 else if (MEM_P (dest))
1010 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1011 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1012 code = GET_CODE (src);
1014 switch (code)
1016 case PRE_MODIFY:
1017 case POST_MODIFY:
1018 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1020 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1021 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1022 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1023 && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1024 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1025 break;
1027 return 0;
1029 case PRE_DEC:
1030 case POST_DEC:
1031 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1033 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1034 break;
1036 return 0;
1038 case PRE_INC:
1039 case POST_INC:
1040 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1042 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1043 break;
1045 return 0;
1047 default:
1048 return 0;
1051 else
1052 return 0;
1054 return offset;
1057 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1058 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1059 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1061 static void
1062 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1064 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1065 const char *label;
1066 int i;
1068 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1069 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1070 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1071 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1072 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1073 return;
1075 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1076 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1077 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1079 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1081 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1082 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1083 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1084 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1085 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1086 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1087 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1088 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1090 return;
1093 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1095 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1096 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1097 return;
1099 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1101 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1102 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1103 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1104 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1105 offset = -args_size;
1106 #else
1107 offset = args_size;
1108 #endif
1110 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1111 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1112 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1113 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1115 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1116 for them. */
1117 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1118 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1119 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1121 else
1122 return;
1124 if (offset == 0)
1125 return;
1127 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1128 cfa.offset += offset;
1130 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1131 offset = -offset;
1132 #endif
1134 args_size += offset;
1135 if (args_size < 0)
1136 args_size = 0;
1138 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1139 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1140 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1141 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1144 #endif
1146 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1147 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1148 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1150 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1152 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1153 rtx reg;
1154 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1155 rtx saved_reg;
1158 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1160 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1161 struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1162 rtx orig_reg;
1163 rtx saved_in_reg;
1166 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1167 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1168 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1169 more efficient data structure. */
1170 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1171 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1173 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1174 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1176 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1177 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1179 static void
1180 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1182 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1184 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1185 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1186 order. */
1187 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1188 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1189 break;
1191 if (q == NULL)
1193 q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1194 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1195 queued_reg_saves = q;
1198 q->reg = reg;
1199 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1200 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1202 last_reg_save_label = label;
1205 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1207 static void
1208 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1210 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1212 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1214 size_t i;
1215 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1217 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1218 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1219 break;
1220 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1222 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1223 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1225 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1227 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1228 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1231 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1232 if (q->saved_reg)
1233 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1234 else
1235 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1236 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1239 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1240 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1243 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1244 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1245 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1246 have a new location for? */
1248 static bool
1249 clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1251 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1253 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1255 size_t i;
1256 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1257 return true;
1258 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1259 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1260 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1261 return true;
1264 return false;
1267 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1269 void
1270 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1272 size_t i;
1273 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1275 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1276 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1277 break;
1278 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1280 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1281 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1283 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1284 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1286 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1287 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1288 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1291 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1293 static rtx
1294 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1296 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1297 size_t i;
1298 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1300 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1301 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1302 return q->reg;
1304 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1305 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1306 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1307 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1309 return NULL_RTX;
1313 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1314 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1315 value, not an offset. */
1316 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1318 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1319 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1320 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1321 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1323 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1324 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1325 users need not read the source code.
1327 The High-Level Picture
1329 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1330 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1331 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1332 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1333 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1335 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1336 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1337 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1338 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1339 saves. This also seems to work.
1341 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1342 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1343 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1344 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1345 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1346 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1347 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1348 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1349 value as in the caller.
1351 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1352 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1353 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1354 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1356 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1357 register,
1359 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1361 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1362 consists of a register and an offset.
1363 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1364 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1365 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1366 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1367 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1368 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1369 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1371 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1372 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1373 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1374 cfa_temp.offset.
1376 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1377 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1378 and cfa_temp.offset.
1380 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1381 stack.
1383 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1384 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1385 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1387 The Rules
1389 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1390 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1392 Rule 1:
1393 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1394 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1395 cfa.offset unchanged
1396 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1397 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1399 Rule 2:
1400 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1401 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1402 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1403 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1404 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1405 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1407 Rule 3:
1408 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1409 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1410 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1412 Rule 4:
1413 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1414 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1415 <reg1> != sp
1416 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1417 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1418 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1420 Rule 5:
1421 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1422 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1423 <reg1> != sp
1424 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1425 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1427 Rule 6:
1428 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1429 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1430 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1432 Rule 7:
1433 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1434 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1435 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1437 Rule 8:
1438 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1439 effects: none
1441 Rule 9:
1442 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1443 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1444 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1446 Rule 10:
1447 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1448 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1449 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1450 cfa.reg = sp
1451 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1453 Rule 11:
1454 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1455 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1456 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1457 cfa.reg = sp
1458 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1460 Rule 12:
1461 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1463 <reg2>)
1464 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1465 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1467 Rule 13:
1468 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1469 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1470 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1472 Rule 14:
1473 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1474 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1475 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1476 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1478   Rule 15:
1479   (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1480   effects: target-dependent */
1482 static void
1483 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1485 rtx src, dest;
1486 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1488 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1489 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1490 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1491 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1492 flag is set in them. */
1493 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1495 int par_index;
1496 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1498 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1499 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1500 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1501 || par_index == 0))
1502 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1504 return;
1507 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1509 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1510 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1512 if (REG_P (src))
1514 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1515 if (rsi)
1516 src = rsi;
1519 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1521 case REG:
1522 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1524 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1525 case REG:
1526 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1528 /* Rule 1 */
1529 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1530 relative to the current CFA register.
1532 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1533 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1534 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1535 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1536 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1537 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1538 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1540 else
1542 /* Saving a register in a register. */
1543 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1544 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
1545 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1546 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1547 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1549 break;
1551 case PLUS:
1552 case MINUS:
1553 case LO_SUM:
1554 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1556 /* Rule 2 */
1557 /* Adjusting SP. */
1558 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1560 case CONST_INT:
1561 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1562 break;
1563 case REG:
1564 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1565 == cfa_temp.reg);
1566 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1567 break;
1568 default:
1569 gcc_unreachable ();
1572 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1574 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1575 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1576 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1578 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1579 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1581 else
1582 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1584 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1585 offset = -offset;
1586 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1587 cfa.offset += offset;
1588 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1589 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1591 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1593 /* Rule 3 */
1594 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1595 or adjusting the FP */
1596 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1598 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1599 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1600 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1601 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1602 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1603 offset = -offset;
1604 cfa.offset += offset;
1605 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1607 else
1609 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1611 /* Rule 4 */
1612 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1613 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1614 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1616 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1617 into the FP later on. */
1618 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1619 cfa.offset += offset;
1620 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1621 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1622 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1623 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1626 /* Rule 5 */
1627 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1628 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1629 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1631 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1632 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1633 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1634 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1635 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1638 /* Rule 9 */
1639 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1640 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1642 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1643 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1645 else
1646 gcc_unreachable ();
1648 break;
1650 /* Rule 6 */
1651 case CONST_INT:
1652 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1653 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1654 break;
1656 /* Rule 7 */
1657 case IOR:
1658 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1659 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1660 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1662 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1663 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1664 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1665 break;
1667 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1668 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1669 /* Rule 8 */
1670 case HIGH:
1671 break;
1673 /* Rule 15 */
1674 case UNSPEC:
1675 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1676 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1677 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1678 return;
1680 default:
1681 gcc_unreachable ();
1684 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1685 break;
1687 case MEM:
1688 gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1690 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1691 CFA register. */
1692 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1694 /* Rule 10 */
1695 /* With a push. */
1696 case PRE_MODIFY:
1697 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1698 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1699 == CONST_INT);
1700 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1702 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1703 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1705 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1706 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1707 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1709 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1710 break;
1712 /* Rule 11 */
1713 case PRE_INC:
1714 case PRE_DEC:
1715 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1716 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1717 offset = -offset;
1719 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1720 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1722 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1723 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1724 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1726 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1727 break;
1729 /* Rule 12 */
1730 /* With an offset. */
1731 case PLUS:
1732 case MINUS:
1733 case LO_SUM:
1735 int regno;
1737 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1738 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1739 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1740 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1741 offset = -offset;
1743 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1745 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1746 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1747 else
1749 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1750 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1753 break;
1755 /* Rule 13 */
1756 /* Without an offset. */
1757 case REG:
1759 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1761 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1762 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1763 else
1765 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1766 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1769 break;
1771 /* Rule 14 */
1772 case POST_INC:
1773 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1774 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1775 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1776 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1777 break;
1779 default:
1780 gcc_unreachable ();
1783 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1784 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1785 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1787 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1789 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1791 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1792 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1793 on the ARM. */
1794 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1795 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1796 break;
1798 else
1800 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1801 calculate the CFA. */
1802 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1804 if (!REG_P (x))
1805 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1806 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1808 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1809 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1810 cfa.indirect = 1;
1811 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1812 break;
1816 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1817 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1818 break;
1820 default:
1821 gcc_unreachable ();
1825 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1826 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1827 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1829 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1830 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
1832 void
1833 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1835 const char *label;
1836 rtx src;
1838 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1840 size_t i;
1842 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1843 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1845 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1846 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1847 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1848 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1850 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1851 cfa_store = cfa;
1852 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1853 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1855 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1857 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1858 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1860 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1861 return;
1864 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1865 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1867 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1869 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1870 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1871 return;
1874 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1875 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1876 if (src)
1877 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1878 else
1879 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1881 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1884 #endif
1886 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
1887 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1888 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1890 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1891 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1893 switch (cfi)
1895 case DW_CFA_nop:
1896 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1897 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1899 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1900 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1901 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1902 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1903 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1904 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1906 case DW_CFA_offset:
1907 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1908 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1909 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1910 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1911 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1912 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1913 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1914 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1915 case DW_CFA_register:
1916 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1918 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1919 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1920 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1921 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1923 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1924 case DW_CFA_expression:
1925 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1927 default:
1928 gcc_unreachable ();
1932 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
1933 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1934 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1936 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1937 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1939 switch (cfi)
1941 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1942 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1943 case DW_CFA_offset:
1944 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1945 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1946 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1948 case DW_CFA_register:
1949 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1951 default:
1952 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1956 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1958 /* Switch to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
1959 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
1960 for collect2. */
1962 static void
1963 switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
1965 tree label;
1967 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
1968 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
1970 int flags;
1972 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
1974 int fde_encoding;
1975 int per_encoding;
1976 int lsda_encoding;
1978 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
1979 /*global=*/0);
1980 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
1981 /*global=*/1);
1982 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
1983 /*global=*/0);
1984 flags = ((! flag_pic
1985 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
1986 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
1987 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
1988 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
1989 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
1990 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
1991 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
1993 else
1994 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
1995 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
1997 #endif
1999 if (eh_frame_section)
2000 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
2001 else
2003 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
2004 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
2005 switch_to_section (data_section);
2006 label = get_file_function_name ('F');
2007 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2008 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
2009 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2010 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2014 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
2015 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
2016 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
2017 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
2018 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
2019 #endif
2021 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
2023 static void
2024 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
2026 unsigned long r;
2027 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
2028 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
2029 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
2030 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
2031 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
2032 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
2034 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2035 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2036 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
2037 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2039 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
2041 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2042 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2043 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
2045 else
2047 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
2048 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
2050 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
2052 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2053 if (for_eh)
2054 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2055 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2056 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
2057 false, NULL);
2058 else
2059 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2060 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
2061 break;
2063 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2064 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2065 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2066 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2067 break;
2069 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2070 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2071 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2072 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2073 break;
2075 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2076 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2077 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2078 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2079 break;
2081 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2082 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2083 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2084 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2085 break;
2087 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2088 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2089 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2090 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2091 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2092 break;
2094 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2095 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2096 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2097 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2098 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2099 break;
2101 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2102 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2103 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2104 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2105 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2106 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2107 break;
2109 case DW_CFA_register:
2110 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2111 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2112 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2113 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2114 break;
2116 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2117 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2118 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2119 break;
2121 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2122 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2123 break;
2125 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2126 break;
2128 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2129 case DW_CFA_expression:
2130 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2131 break;
2133 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2134 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
2135 gcc_unreachable ();
2137 default:
2138 break;
2143 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2144 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2145 location of saved registers. */
2147 static void
2148 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2150 unsigned int i;
2151 dw_fde_ref fde;
2152 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2153 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2154 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2155 char augmentation[6];
2156 int augmentation_size;
2157 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2158 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2159 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2160 int return_reg;
2162 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
2163 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2164 return;
2166 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2167 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
2168 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2169 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
2170 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2171 specialization doesn't. */
2172 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2173 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2174 && for_eh)
2175 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2176 if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2177 && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2178 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2179 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2180 for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2182 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2183 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
2184 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2185 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
2186 if (for_eh)
2188 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2190 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2191 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2192 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2193 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2194 any_eh_needed = true;
2195 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2196 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2197 any_eh_needed = true;
2199 if (! any_eh_needed)
2200 return;
2203 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
2204 if (flag_debug_asm)
2205 app_enable ();
2207 if (for_eh)
2208 switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2209 else
2210 switch_to_section (get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
2212 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2213 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2215 /* Output the CIE. */
2216 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2217 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2218 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2219 "Length of Common Information Entry");
2220 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2222 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2223 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
2224 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2225 (for_eh ? 0 : DW_CIE_ID),
2226 "CIE Identifier Tag");
2228 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2230 augmentation[0] = 0;
2231 augmentation_size = 0;
2232 if (for_eh)
2234 char *p;
2236 /* Augmentation:
2237 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2238 augmentation section.
2239 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2240 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2241 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2242 FDE code pointers.
2243 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2244 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
2246 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2247 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2248 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2250 p = augmentation + 1;
2251 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2253 *p++ = 'P';
2254 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2256 if (any_lsda_needed)
2258 *p++ = 'L';
2259 augmentation_size += 1;
2261 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2263 *p++ = 'R';
2264 augmentation_size += 1;
2266 if (p > augmentation + 1)
2268 augmentation[0] = 'z';
2269 *p = '\0';
2272 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
2273 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2275 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2276 + 4 /* CIE Id */
2277 + 1 /* CIE version */
2278 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
2279 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
2280 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2281 + 1 /* RA column */
2282 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
2283 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
2284 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2286 augmentation_size += pad;
2288 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2289 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
2290 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2294 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2295 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2296 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2297 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2299 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2300 if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2301 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2302 else
2303 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2305 if (augmentation[0])
2307 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2308 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2310 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2311 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2312 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2313 eh_personality_libfunc,
2314 true, NULL);
2317 if (any_lsda_needed)
2318 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2319 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2321 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2322 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2323 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2326 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2327 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2329 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
2330 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2331 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2332 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2334 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
2335 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2337 fde = &fde_table[i];
2339 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
2340 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2341 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2342 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2343 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2344 continue;
2346 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2347 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2348 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2349 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2350 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2351 "FDE Length");
2352 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2354 if (for_eh)
2355 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2356 else
2357 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2358 "FDE CIE offset");
2360 if (for_eh)
2362 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2363 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2364 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2365 sym_ref,
2366 false,
2367 "FDE initial location");
2368 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2370 rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2371 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2372 rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2373 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2374 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2375 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2376 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3, false,
2377 "FDE initial location");
2378 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2379 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2380 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2381 "FDE address range");
2382 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2, false,
2383 "FDE initial location");
2384 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2385 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2386 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2387 "FDE address range");
2389 else
2390 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2391 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2392 "FDE address range");
2394 else
2396 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2397 "FDE initial location");
2398 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2400 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2401 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2402 "FDE initial location");
2403 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2404 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2405 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2406 "FDE address range");
2407 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2408 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2409 "FDE initial location");
2410 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2411 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2412 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2413 "FDE address range");
2415 else
2416 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2417 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2418 "FDE address range");
2421 if (augmentation[0])
2423 if (any_lsda_needed)
2425 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2427 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2429 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2430 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2431 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2432 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2433 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2435 size += pad;
2436 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2439 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2441 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2443 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2444 fde->funcdef_number);
2445 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2446 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2447 false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2449 else
2451 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2452 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2453 dw2_asm_output_data
2454 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2455 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2458 else
2459 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2462 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2463 this FDE. */
2464 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2465 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2466 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2468 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2469 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2470 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2471 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2474 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2475 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2476 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2477 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2478 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2479 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2480 #endif
2482 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2483 if (flag_debug_asm)
2484 app_disable ();
2487 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2488 the prologue. */
2490 void
2491 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2492 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2494 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2495 char * dup_label;
2496 dw_fde_ref fde;
2498 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2500 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2501 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2502 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2503 be used. */
2504 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2505 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2506 return;
2507 #else
2508 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2509 return;
2510 #endif
2512 switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
2513 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2514 current_function_funcdef_no);
2515 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2516 current_function_funcdef_no);
2517 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2518 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2520 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2521 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2522 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2523 return;
2524 #endif
2526 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2527 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2529 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2530 fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2531 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2532 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2533 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2536 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2537 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2539 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2540 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2541 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2542 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2543 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
2544 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2545 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2546 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2547 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2548 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2549 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2550 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2551 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2552 fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2553 fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2554 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2556 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2558 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2559 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2560 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2561 if (file)
2562 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2563 #endif
2566 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2567 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2568 been generated. */
2570 void
2571 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2572 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2574 dw_fde_ref fde;
2575 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2577 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2578 function. */
2579 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2580 current_function_funcdef_no);
2581 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2582 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2583 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2586 void
2587 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2589 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2590 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2591 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2592 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2594 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2595 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2597 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2598 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2600 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2601 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2602 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2603 #endif
2606 void
2607 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2609 /* Output call frame information. */
2610 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2611 output_call_frame_info (0);
2613 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2614 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
2615 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2616 output_call_frame_info (1);
2617 #endif
2619 #endif
2621 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2622 for emitting location expressions. */
2624 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2625 relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
2626 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2629 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2630 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2631 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2632 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2634 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2635 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2636 implementation are listed below. */
2638 enum dw_val_class
2640 dw_val_class_addr,
2641 dw_val_class_offset,
2642 dw_val_class_loc,
2643 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2644 dw_val_class_range_list,
2645 dw_val_class_const,
2646 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2647 dw_val_class_long_long,
2648 dw_val_class_vec,
2649 dw_val_class_flag,
2650 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2651 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2652 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2653 dw_val_class_lbl_offset,
2654 dw_val_class_str
2657 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2658 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2660 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2662 unsigned long hi;
2663 unsigned long low;
2665 dw_long_long_const;
2667 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
2669 typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2671 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2672 unsigned length;
2673 unsigned elt_size;
2675 dw_vec_const;
2677 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2678 represented internally. */
2680 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2682 enum dw_val_class val_class;
2683 union dw_val_struct_union
2685 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2686 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2687 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2688 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2689 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2690 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2691 dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2692 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2693 struct dw_val_die_union
2695 dw_die_ref die;
2696 int external;
2697 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2698 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2699 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2700 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2701 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2703 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2705 dw_val_node;
2707 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2708 operations. */
2710 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2712 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2713 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2714 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2715 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2716 int dw_loc_addr;
2718 dw_loc_descr_node;
2720 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2721 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2722 their entire life. */
2723 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2725 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2726 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2727 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2728 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2729 Only on head of list */
2730 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2731 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2732 } dw_loc_list_node;
2734 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2736 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2737 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2738 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2739 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2740 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2741 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2742 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2743 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2745 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2747 static const char *
2748 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2750 switch (op)
2752 case DW_OP_addr:
2753 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2754 return "DW_OP_addr";
2755 case DW_OP_deref:
2756 return "DW_OP_deref";
2757 case DW_OP_const1u:
2758 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2759 case DW_OP_const1s:
2760 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2761 case DW_OP_const2u:
2762 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2763 case DW_OP_const2s:
2764 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2765 case DW_OP_const4u:
2766 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2767 case DW_OP_const4s:
2768 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2769 case DW_OP_const8u:
2770 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2771 case DW_OP_const8s:
2772 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2773 case DW_OP_constu:
2774 return "DW_OP_constu";
2775 case DW_OP_consts:
2776 return "DW_OP_consts";
2777 case DW_OP_dup:
2778 return "DW_OP_dup";
2779 case DW_OP_drop:
2780 return "DW_OP_drop";
2781 case DW_OP_over:
2782 return "DW_OP_over";
2783 case DW_OP_pick:
2784 return "DW_OP_pick";
2785 case DW_OP_swap:
2786 return "DW_OP_swap";
2787 case DW_OP_rot:
2788 return "DW_OP_rot";
2789 case DW_OP_xderef:
2790 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2791 case DW_OP_abs:
2792 return "DW_OP_abs";
2793 case DW_OP_and:
2794 return "DW_OP_and";
2795 case DW_OP_div:
2796 return "DW_OP_div";
2797 case DW_OP_minus:
2798 return "DW_OP_minus";
2799 case DW_OP_mod:
2800 return "DW_OP_mod";
2801 case DW_OP_mul:
2802 return "DW_OP_mul";
2803 case DW_OP_neg:
2804 return "DW_OP_neg";
2805 case DW_OP_not:
2806 return "DW_OP_not";
2807 case DW_OP_or:
2808 return "DW_OP_or";
2809 case DW_OP_plus:
2810 return "DW_OP_plus";
2811 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2812 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2813 case DW_OP_shl:
2814 return "DW_OP_shl";
2815 case DW_OP_shr:
2816 return "DW_OP_shr";
2817 case DW_OP_shra:
2818 return "DW_OP_shra";
2819 case DW_OP_xor:
2820 return "DW_OP_xor";
2821 case DW_OP_bra:
2822 return "DW_OP_bra";
2823 case DW_OP_eq:
2824 return "DW_OP_eq";
2825 case DW_OP_ge:
2826 return "DW_OP_ge";
2827 case DW_OP_gt:
2828 return "DW_OP_gt";
2829 case DW_OP_le:
2830 return "DW_OP_le";
2831 case DW_OP_lt:
2832 return "DW_OP_lt";
2833 case DW_OP_ne:
2834 return "DW_OP_ne";
2835 case DW_OP_skip:
2836 return "DW_OP_skip";
2837 case DW_OP_lit0:
2838 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2839 case DW_OP_lit1:
2840 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2841 case DW_OP_lit2:
2842 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2843 case DW_OP_lit3:
2844 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2845 case DW_OP_lit4:
2846 return "DW_OP_lit4";
2847 case DW_OP_lit5:
2848 return "DW_OP_lit5";
2849 case DW_OP_lit6:
2850 return "DW_OP_lit6";
2851 case DW_OP_lit7:
2852 return "DW_OP_lit7";
2853 case DW_OP_lit8:
2854 return "DW_OP_lit8";
2855 case DW_OP_lit9:
2856 return "DW_OP_lit9";
2857 case DW_OP_lit10:
2858 return "DW_OP_lit10";
2859 case DW_OP_lit11:
2860 return "DW_OP_lit11";
2861 case DW_OP_lit12:
2862 return "DW_OP_lit12";
2863 case DW_OP_lit13:
2864 return "DW_OP_lit13";
2865 case DW_OP_lit14:
2866 return "DW_OP_lit14";
2867 case DW_OP_lit15:
2868 return "DW_OP_lit15";
2869 case DW_OP_lit16:
2870 return "DW_OP_lit16";
2871 case DW_OP_lit17:
2872 return "DW_OP_lit17";
2873 case DW_OP_lit18:
2874 return "DW_OP_lit18";
2875 case DW_OP_lit19:
2876 return "DW_OP_lit19";
2877 case DW_OP_lit20:
2878 return "DW_OP_lit20";
2879 case DW_OP_lit21:
2880 return "DW_OP_lit21";
2881 case DW_OP_lit22:
2882 return "DW_OP_lit22";
2883 case DW_OP_lit23:
2884 return "DW_OP_lit23";
2885 case DW_OP_lit24:
2886 return "DW_OP_lit24";
2887 case DW_OP_lit25:
2888 return "DW_OP_lit25";
2889 case DW_OP_lit26:
2890 return "DW_OP_lit26";
2891 case DW_OP_lit27:
2892 return "DW_OP_lit27";
2893 case DW_OP_lit28:
2894 return "DW_OP_lit28";
2895 case DW_OP_lit29:
2896 return "DW_OP_lit29";
2897 case DW_OP_lit30:
2898 return "DW_OP_lit30";
2899 case DW_OP_lit31:
2900 return "DW_OP_lit31";
2901 case DW_OP_reg0:
2902 return "DW_OP_reg0";
2903 case DW_OP_reg1:
2904 return "DW_OP_reg1";
2905 case DW_OP_reg2:
2906 return "DW_OP_reg2";
2907 case DW_OP_reg3:
2908 return "DW_OP_reg3";
2909 case DW_OP_reg4:
2910 return "DW_OP_reg4";
2911 case DW_OP_reg5:
2912 return "DW_OP_reg5";
2913 case DW_OP_reg6:
2914 return "DW_OP_reg6";
2915 case DW_OP_reg7:
2916 return "DW_OP_reg7";
2917 case DW_OP_reg8:
2918 return "DW_OP_reg8";
2919 case DW_OP_reg9:
2920 return "DW_OP_reg9";
2921 case DW_OP_reg10:
2922 return "DW_OP_reg10";
2923 case DW_OP_reg11:
2924 return "DW_OP_reg11";
2925 case DW_OP_reg12:
2926 return "DW_OP_reg12";
2927 case DW_OP_reg13:
2928 return "DW_OP_reg13";
2929 case DW_OP_reg14:
2930 return "DW_OP_reg14";
2931 case DW_OP_reg15:
2932 return "DW_OP_reg15";
2933 case DW_OP_reg16:
2934 return "DW_OP_reg16";
2935 case DW_OP_reg17:
2936 return "DW_OP_reg17";
2937 case DW_OP_reg18:
2938 return "DW_OP_reg18";
2939 case DW_OP_reg19:
2940 return "DW_OP_reg19";
2941 case DW_OP_reg20:
2942 return "DW_OP_reg20";
2943 case DW_OP_reg21:
2944 return "DW_OP_reg21";
2945 case DW_OP_reg22:
2946 return "DW_OP_reg22";
2947 case DW_OP_reg23:
2948 return "DW_OP_reg23";
2949 case DW_OP_reg24:
2950 return "DW_OP_reg24";
2951 case DW_OP_reg25:
2952 return "DW_OP_reg25";
2953 case DW_OP_reg26:
2954 return "DW_OP_reg26";
2955 case DW_OP_reg27:
2956 return "DW_OP_reg27";
2957 case DW_OP_reg28:
2958 return "DW_OP_reg28";
2959 case DW_OP_reg29:
2960 return "DW_OP_reg29";
2961 case DW_OP_reg30:
2962 return "DW_OP_reg30";
2963 case DW_OP_reg31:
2964 return "DW_OP_reg31";
2965 case DW_OP_breg0:
2966 return "DW_OP_breg0";
2967 case DW_OP_breg1:
2968 return "DW_OP_breg1";
2969 case DW_OP_breg2:
2970 return "DW_OP_breg2";
2971 case DW_OP_breg3:
2972 return "DW_OP_breg3";
2973 case DW_OP_breg4:
2974 return "DW_OP_breg4";
2975 case DW_OP_breg5:
2976 return "DW_OP_breg5";
2977 case DW_OP_breg6:
2978 return "DW_OP_breg6";
2979 case DW_OP_breg7:
2980 return "DW_OP_breg7";
2981 case DW_OP_breg8:
2982 return "DW_OP_breg8";
2983 case DW_OP_breg9:
2984 return "DW_OP_breg9";
2985 case DW_OP_breg10:
2986 return "DW_OP_breg10";
2987 case DW_OP_breg11:
2988 return "DW_OP_breg11";
2989 case DW_OP_breg12:
2990 return "DW_OP_breg12";
2991 case DW_OP_breg13:
2992 return "DW_OP_breg13";
2993 case DW_OP_breg14:
2994 return "DW_OP_breg14";
2995 case DW_OP_breg15:
2996 return "DW_OP_breg15";
2997 case DW_OP_breg16:
2998 return "DW_OP_breg16";
2999 case DW_OP_breg17:
3000 return "DW_OP_breg17";
3001 case DW_OP_breg18:
3002 return "DW_OP_breg18";
3003 case DW_OP_breg19:
3004 return "DW_OP_breg19";
3005 case DW_OP_breg20:
3006 return "DW_OP_breg20";
3007 case DW_OP_breg21:
3008 return "DW_OP_breg21";
3009 case DW_OP_breg22:
3010 return "DW_OP_breg22";
3011 case DW_OP_breg23:
3012 return "DW_OP_breg23";
3013 case DW_OP_breg24:
3014 return "DW_OP_breg24";
3015 case DW_OP_breg25:
3016 return "DW_OP_breg25";
3017 case DW_OP_breg26:
3018 return "DW_OP_breg26";
3019 case DW_OP_breg27:
3020 return "DW_OP_breg27";
3021 case DW_OP_breg28:
3022 return "DW_OP_breg28";
3023 case DW_OP_breg29:
3024 return "DW_OP_breg29";
3025 case DW_OP_breg30:
3026 return "DW_OP_breg30";
3027 case DW_OP_breg31:
3028 return "DW_OP_breg31";
3029 case DW_OP_regx:
3030 return "DW_OP_regx";
3031 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3032 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3033 case DW_OP_bregx:
3034 return "DW_OP_bregx";
3035 case DW_OP_piece:
3036 return "DW_OP_piece";
3037 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3038 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3039 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3040 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3041 case DW_OP_nop:
3042 return "DW_OP_nop";
3043 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
3044 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3045 case DW_OP_call2:
3046 return "DW_OP_call2";
3047 case DW_OP_call4:
3048 return "DW_OP_call4";
3049 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3050 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3051 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
3052 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3053 default:
3054 return "OP_<unknown>";
3058 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
3059 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3060 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
3062 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3063 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
3064 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
3066 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
3068 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
3069 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3070 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
3071 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3072 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
3074 return descr;
3077 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
3079 static inline void
3080 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3082 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3084 /* Find the end of the chain. */
3085 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3088 *d = descr;
3091 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
3093 static unsigned long
3094 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3096 unsigned long size = 1;
3098 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3100 case DW_OP_addr:
3101 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3102 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3103 break;
3104 case DW_OP_const1u:
3105 case DW_OP_const1s:
3106 size += 1;
3107 break;
3108 case DW_OP_const2u:
3109 case DW_OP_const2s:
3110 size += 2;
3111 break;
3112 case DW_OP_const4u:
3113 case DW_OP_const4s:
3114 size += 4;
3115 break;
3116 case DW_OP_const8u:
3117 case DW_OP_const8s:
3118 size += 8;
3119 break;
3120 case DW_OP_constu:
3121 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3122 break;
3123 case DW_OP_consts:
3124 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3125 break;
3126 case DW_OP_pick:
3127 size += 1;
3128 break;
3129 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3130 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3131 break;
3132 case DW_OP_skip:
3133 case DW_OP_bra:
3134 size += 2;
3135 break;
3136 case DW_OP_breg0:
3137 case DW_OP_breg1:
3138 case DW_OP_breg2:
3139 case DW_OP_breg3:
3140 case DW_OP_breg4:
3141 case DW_OP_breg5:
3142 case DW_OP_breg6:
3143 case DW_OP_breg7:
3144 case DW_OP_breg8:
3145 case DW_OP_breg9:
3146 case DW_OP_breg10:
3147 case DW_OP_breg11:
3148 case DW_OP_breg12:
3149 case DW_OP_breg13:
3150 case DW_OP_breg14:
3151 case DW_OP_breg15:
3152 case DW_OP_breg16:
3153 case DW_OP_breg17:
3154 case DW_OP_breg18:
3155 case DW_OP_breg19:
3156 case DW_OP_breg20:
3157 case DW_OP_breg21:
3158 case DW_OP_breg22:
3159 case DW_OP_breg23:
3160 case DW_OP_breg24:
3161 case DW_OP_breg25:
3162 case DW_OP_breg26:
3163 case DW_OP_breg27:
3164 case DW_OP_breg28:
3165 case DW_OP_breg29:
3166 case DW_OP_breg30:
3167 case DW_OP_breg31:
3168 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3169 break;
3170 case DW_OP_regx:
3171 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3172 break;
3173 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3174 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3175 break;
3176 case DW_OP_bregx:
3177 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3178 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3179 break;
3180 case DW_OP_piece:
3181 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3182 break;
3183 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3184 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3185 size += 1;
3186 break;
3187 case DW_OP_call2:
3188 size += 2;
3189 break;
3190 case DW_OP_call4:
3191 size += 4;
3192 break;
3193 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3194 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3195 break;
3196 default:
3197 break;
3200 return size;
3203 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
3205 static unsigned long
3206 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3208 unsigned long size;
3210 for (size = 0; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3212 loc->dw_loc_addr = size;
3213 size += size_of_loc_descr (loc);
3216 return size;
3219 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
3221 static void
3222 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3224 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3225 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3227 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3229 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3230 case DW_OP_addr:
3231 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3232 break;
3233 case DW_OP_const2u:
3234 case DW_OP_const2s:
3235 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3236 break;
3237 case DW_OP_const4u:
3238 case DW_OP_const4s:
3239 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3240 break;
3241 case DW_OP_const8u:
3242 case DW_OP_const8s:
3243 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3244 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3245 break;
3246 case DW_OP_skip:
3247 case DW_OP_bra:
3249 int offset;
3251 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3252 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3254 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3256 break;
3257 #else
3258 case DW_OP_addr:
3259 case DW_OP_const2u:
3260 case DW_OP_const2s:
3261 case DW_OP_const4u:
3262 case DW_OP_const4s:
3263 case DW_OP_const8u:
3264 case DW_OP_const8s:
3265 case DW_OP_skip:
3266 case DW_OP_bra:
3267 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3268 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3269 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3270 only doing unwinding. */
3271 gcc_unreachable ();
3272 #endif
3273 case DW_OP_const1u:
3274 case DW_OP_const1s:
3275 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3276 break;
3277 case DW_OP_constu:
3278 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3279 break;
3280 case DW_OP_consts:
3281 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3282 break;
3283 case DW_OP_pick:
3284 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3285 break;
3286 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3287 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3288 break;
3289 case DW_OP_breg0:
3290 case DW_OP_breg1:
3291 case DW_OP_breg2:
3292 case DW_OP_breg3:
3293 case DW_OP_breg4:
3294 case DW_OP_breg5:
3295 case DW_OP_breg6:
3296 case DW_OP_breg7:
3297 case DW_OP_breg8:
3298 case DW_OP_breg9:
3299 case DW_OP_breg10:
3300 case DW_OP_breg11:
3301 case DW_OP_breg12:
3302 case DW_OP_breg13:
3303 case DW_OP_breg14:
3304 case DW_OP_breg15:
3305 case DW_OP_breg16:
3306 case DW_OP_breg17:
3307 case DW_OP_breg18:
3308 case DW_OP_breg19:
3309 case DW_OP_breg20:
3310 case DW_OP_breg21:
3311 case DW_OP_breg22:
3312 case DW_OP_breg23:
3313 case DW_OP_breg24:
3314 case DW_OP_breg25:
3315 case DW_OP_breg26:
3316 case DW_OP_breg27:
3317 case DW_OP_breg28:
3318 case DW_OP_breg29:
3319 case DW_OP_breg30:
3320 case DW_OP_breg31:
3321 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3322 break;
3323 case DW_OP_regx:
3324 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3325 break;
3326 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3327 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3328 break;
3329 case DW_OP_bregx:
3330 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3331 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3332 break;
3333 case DW_OP_piece:
3334 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3335 break;
3336 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3337 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3338 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3339 break;
3341 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3342 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
3344 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
3345 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3346 val1->v.val_addr);
3347 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3349 else
3350 gcc_unreachable ();
3351 break;
3353 default:
3354 /* Other codes have no operands. */
3355 break;
3359 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
3361 static void
3362 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3364 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3366 /* Output the opcode. */
3367 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3368 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3370 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
3371 output_loc_operands (loc);
3375 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3376 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
3378 static void
3379 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3381 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3382 unsigned long size;
3384 /* Output the size of the block. */
3385 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3386 size = size_of_locs (loc);
3387 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3389 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
3390 output_loc_sequence (loc);
3393 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3394 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3395 expression. */
3397 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
3398 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3400 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3402 offset += cfa->offset;
3404 if (cfa->indirect)
3406 if (cfa->base_offset)
3408 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3409 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3410 else
3411 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3413 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3414 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3415 else
3416 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3418 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3419 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3420 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3421 if (offset != 0)
3423 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
3424 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3427 else
3429 if (offset == 0)
3430 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3431 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3432 else
3433 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3434 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3435 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, offset, 0);
3436 else
3437 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, offset);
3440 return head;
3443 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3444 descriptor sequence. */
3446 static void
3447 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3449 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3450 cfa->offset = 0;
3451 cfa->base_offset = 0;
3452 cfa->indirect = 0;
3453 cfa->reg = -1;
3455 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3457 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3459 switch (op)
3461 case DW_OP_reg0:
3462 case DW_OP_reg1:
3463 case DW_OP_reg2:
3464 case DW_OP_reg3:
3465 case DW_OP_reg4:
3466 case DW_OP_reg5:
3467 case DW_OP_reg6:
3468 case DW_OP_reg7:
3469 case DW_OP_reg8:
3470 case DW_OP_reg9:
3471 case DW_OP_reg10:
3472 case DW_OP_reg11:
3473 case DW_OP_reg12:
3474 case DW_OP_reg13:
3475 case DW_OP_reg14:
3476 case DW_OP_reg15:
3477 case DW_OP_reg16:
3478 case DW_OP_reg17:
3479 case DW_OP_reg18:
3480 case DW_OP_reg19:
3481 case DW_OP_reg20:
3482 case DW_OP_reg21:
3483 case DW_OP_reg22:
3484 case DW_OP_reg23:
3485 case DW_OP_reg24:
3486 case DW_OP_reg25:
3487 case DW_OP_reg26:
3488 case DW_OP_reg27:
3489 case DW_OP_reg28:
3490 case DW_OP_reg29:
3491 case DW_OP_reg30:
3492 case DW_OP_reg31:
3493 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3494 break;
3495 case DW_OP_regx:
3496 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3497 break;
3498 case DW_OP_breg0:
3499 case DW_OP_breg1:
3500 case DW_OP_breg2:
3501 case DW_OP_breg3:
3502 case DW_OP_breg4:
3503 case DW_OP_breg5:
3504 case DW_OP_breg6:
3505 case DW_OP_breg7:
3506 case DW_OP_breg8:
3507 case DW_OP_breg9:
3508 case DW_OP_breg10:
3509 case DW_OP_breg11:
3510 case DW_OP_breg12:
3511 case DW_OP_breg13:
3512 case DW_OP_breg14:
3513 case DW_OP_breg15:
3514 case DW_OP_breg16:
3515 case DW_OP_breg17:
3516 case DW_OP_breg18:
3517 case DW_OP_breg19:
3518 case DW_OP_breg20:
3519 case DW_OP_breg21:
3520 case DW_OP_breg22:
3521 case DW_OP_breg23:
3522 case DW_OP_breg24:
3523 case DW_OP_breg25:
3524 case DW_OP_breg26:
3525 case DW_OP_breg27:
3526 case DW_OP_breg28:
3527 case DW_OP_breg29:
3528 case DW_OP_breg30:
3529 case DW_OP_breg31:
3530 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3531 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3532 break;
3533 case DW_OP_bregx:
3534 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3535 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3536 break;
3537 case DW_OP_deref:
3538 cfa->indirect = 1;
3539 break;
3540 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3541 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3542 break;
3543 default:
3544 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3545 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3549 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3551 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3552 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3554 /* .debug_str support. */
3555 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3557 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3558 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3559 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3560 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3561 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3562 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3563 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3564 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3565 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3566 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3567 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3568 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3569 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3570 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3571 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3572 static void dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void);
3574 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3576 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3578 dwarf2out_init,
3579 dwarf2out_finish,
3580 dwarf2out_define,
3581 dwarf2out_undef,
3582 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3583 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3584 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3585 dwarf2out_end_block,
3586 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3587 dwarf2out_source_line,
3588 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3589 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
3590 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3591 dwarf2out_begin_function,
3592 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3593 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3594 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3595 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
3596 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3597 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3598 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3599 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3600 something tries to reference them. */
3601 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3602 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
3603 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
3604 dwarf2out_var_location,
3605 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3606 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
3608 #endif
3610 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3611 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3612 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3614 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3615 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3616 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3617 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3619 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3620 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3622 typedef long int dw_offset;
3624 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3626 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3627 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3628 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3629 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3630 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3632 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3633 line number associated with the label generated for that
3634 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3635 the line number entry. */
3637 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3639 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3640 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3642 dw_line_info_entry;
3644 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3645 own sequence. */
3646 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3648 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3649 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3650 unsigned long function;
3652 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3654 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3655 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3656 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3658 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3660 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3661 dw_attr_ref dw_attr_next;
3662 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3664 dw_attr_node;
3666 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure */
3668 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3670 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3671 char *die_symbol;
3672 dw_attr_ref die_attr;
3673 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3674 dw_die_ref die_child;
3675 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3676 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3677 dw_offset die_offset;
3678 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3679 int die_mark;
3680 unsigned int decl_id;
3682 die_node;
3684 /* The pubname structure */
3686 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3688 dw_die_ref die;
3689 char *name;
3691 pubname_entry;
3693 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3695 int block_num;
3698 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3699 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3701 dw_die_ref die;
3702 tree created_for;
3703 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3705 limbo_die_node;
3707 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3708 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3709 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3710 #endif
3712 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3713 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3715 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3716 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3717 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3718 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3719 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3720 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3722 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3723 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3724 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3725 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3726 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3727 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3728 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3729 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3730 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3731 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3733 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3734 language, and compiler version. */
3736 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3737 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3738 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3740 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3741 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3743 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3744 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3745 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3746 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3747 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3749 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3750 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3751 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3752 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3753 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3754 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3756 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3757 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3758 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3759 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3760 #else
3761 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3762 #endif
3763 #endif
3765 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3766 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3767 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3769 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3770 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3772 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3773 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3775 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3776 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3777 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3778 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3779 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3781 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3782 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3783 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3784 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3785 #endif
3787 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3788 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3790 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3791 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3793 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3794 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table;
3795 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table_emitted;
3796 static GTY(()) size_t file_table_last_lookup_index;
3798 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3799 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3800 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3802 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3803 struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3805 rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3806 const char * GTY (()) label;
3807 const char * GTY (()) section_label;
3808 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3811 /* Variable location list. */
3812 struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
3814 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3816 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
3817 it is marked through the chain. */
3818 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3820 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3821 unsigned int decl_id;
3823 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3826 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3827 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
3829 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3830 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3831 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3832 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3833 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3835 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3836 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3838 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
3839 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3841 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3842 abbrev_die_table. */
3843 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3845 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3846 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
3847 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3848 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3850 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
3851 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3853 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
3854 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3856 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
3857 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
3859 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3860 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
3861 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3862 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3864 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
3865 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3867 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
3868 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3870 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3871 line_info_table. */
3872 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3874 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3875 accessible names. */
3876 static GTY ((length ("pubname_table_allocated"))) pubname_ref pubname_table;
3878 /* Number of elements currently allocated for pubname_table. */
3879 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_allocated;
3881 /* Number of elements in pubname_table currently in use. */
3882 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_in_use;
3884 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3885 pubname_table. */
3886 #define PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3888 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
3889 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3891 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
3892 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3894 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
3895 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3897 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3898 arange_table. */
3899 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3901 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3902 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3904 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3905 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3907 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3908 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3910 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3911 ranges_table. */
3912 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3914 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3915 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3917 /* Unique label counter. */
3918 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3920 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3921 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
3922 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3923 #endif
3924 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3925 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3926 #endif
3928 /* Number of file tables emitted in maybe_emit_file(). */
3929 static GTY(()) int emitcount = 0;
3931 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3932 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3934 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3936 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3937 within the current function. */
3938 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3940 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3942 static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
3943 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3944 static int is_tagged_type (tree);
3945 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3946 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3947 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3948 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
3949 static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
3950 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3951 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
3952 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
3953 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3954 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
3955 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3956 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
3957 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3958 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
3959 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
3960 unsigned long);
3961 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3962 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3963 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
3964 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
3965 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3966 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
3967 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
3968 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3969 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3970 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
3971 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
3972 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
3973 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3974 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3975 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
3976 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3977 dw_loc_list_ref);
3978 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
3979 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
3980 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
3981 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3982 static void add_AT_lbl_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3983 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3984 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3985 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3986 unsigned long);
3987 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
3988 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3989 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3990 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3991 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3992 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3993 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3994 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3995 static bool is_c_family (void);
3996 static bool is_cxx (void);
3997 static bool is_java (void);
3998 static bool is_fortran (void);
3999 static bool is_ada (void);
4000 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4001 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
4002 static inline void free_die (dw_die_ref);
4003 static void remove_children (dw_die_ref);
4004 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4005 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
4006 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
4007 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4008 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4009 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4010 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
4011 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4012 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4013 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (tree);
4014 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4015 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
4016 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4017 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
4018 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4019 static void reverse_die_lists (dw_die_ref);
4020 static void reverse_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4021 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4022 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
4023 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
4024 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4025 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4026 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
4027 static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
4028 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
4029 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
4030 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4031 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
4032 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
4033 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
4034 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
4035 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
4036 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
4037 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4038 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4039 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4040 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
4041 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
4042 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
4043 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
4044 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
4045 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4046 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
4047 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
4048 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4049 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4050 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4051 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (void);
4052 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4053 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4054 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4055 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4056 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
4057 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
4058 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4059 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
4060 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
4061 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
4062 static void output_pubnames (void);
4063 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
4064 static void output_aranges (void);
4065 static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
4066 static void output_ranges (void);
4067 static void output_line_info (void);
4068 static void output_file_names (void);
4069 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
4070 static tree root_type (tree);
4071 static int is_base_type (tree);
4072 static bool is_subrange_type (tree);
4073 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4074 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4075 static int type_is_enum (tree);
4076 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (rtx);
4077 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
4078 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
4079 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
4080 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4081 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4082 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4083 static int is_based_loc (rtx);
4084 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode);
4085 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4086 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx);
4087 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
4088 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
4089 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
4090 static tree field_type (tree);
4091 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
4092 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
4093 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
4094 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
4095 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4096 dw_loc_descr_ref);
4097 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4098 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
4099 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4100 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4101 static void insert_float (rtx, unsigned char *);
4102 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
4103 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
4104 enum dwarf_attribute);
4105 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4106 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4107 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4108 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4109 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4110 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4111 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4112 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4113 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4114 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4115 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4116 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4117 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4118 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4119 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4120 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4121 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4122 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4123 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4124 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4125 static const char *type_tag (tree);
4126 static tree member_declared_type (tree);
4127 #if 0
4128 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4129 #endif
4130 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4131 #if 0
4132 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4133 #endif
4134 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4135 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4136 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4137 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4138 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4139 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4140 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4141 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4142 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4143 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4144 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4145 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4146 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4147 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4148 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4149 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4150 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4151 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4152 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4153 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4154 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4155 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4156 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4157 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4158 static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
4159 static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4160 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4161 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4162 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4163 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4164 static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4165 static unsigned lookup_filename (const char *);
4166 static void init_file_table (void);
4167 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4168 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4169 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4170 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4171 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4172 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4173 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4174 const char *, const char *,
4175 const char *);
4176 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4177 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4179 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4180 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4181 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4182 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4183 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4184 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4185 static int maybe_emit_file (int);
4187 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
4188 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4189 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
4190 #endif
4191 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4192 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
4193 #endif
4194 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4195 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
4196 #endif
4197 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4198 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
4199 #endif
4200 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4201 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
4202 #endif
4203 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4204 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
4205 #endif
4206 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4207 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
4208 #endif
4209 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4210 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
4211 #endif
4212 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4213 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
4214 #endif
4216 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
4217 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4218 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
4219 #endif
4221 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
4222 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4223 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants \
4224 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
4225 : SECTION_DEBUG)
4227 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4228 the section names themselves. */
4230 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4231 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
4232 #endif
4233 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4234 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
4235 #endif
4236 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4237 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
4238 #endif
4239 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4240 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
4241 #endif
4242 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4243 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
4244 #endif
4245 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4246 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
4247 #endif
4248 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4249 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
4250 #endif
4251 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4252 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
4253 #endif
4255 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4256 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4257 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4258 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4259 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
4261 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4262 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4263 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4264 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4265 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4266 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4267 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4268 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4269 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4270 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4272 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4273 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
4274 #endif
4275 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4276 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
4277 #endif
4278 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4279 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
4280 #endif
4281 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4282 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
4283 #endif
4284 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4285 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
4286 #endif
4287 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4288 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
4289 #endif
4291 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4292 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
4294 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4296 void
4297 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4299 demangle_name_func = func;
4302 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
4304 static inline int
4305 is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
4307 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4308 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4309 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4312 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4313 removed. */
4315 static inline tree
4316 type_main_variant (tree type)
4318 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4320 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4321 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4322 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4323 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4324 here. */
4325 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4326 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4327 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4329 return type;
4332 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4334 static inline int
4335 is_tagged_type (tree type)
4337 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4339 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4340 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4343 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4345 static const char *
4346 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4348 switch (tag)
4350 case DW_TAG_padding:
4351 return "DW_TAG_padding";
4352 case DW_TAG_array_type:
4353 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4354 case DW_TAG_class_type:
4355 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4356 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4357 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4358 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4359 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4360 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4361 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4362 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4363 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4364 case DW_TAG_label:
4365 return "DW_TAG_label";
4366 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4367 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4368 case DW_TAG_member:
4369 return "DW_TAG_member";
4370 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4371 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4372 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4373 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4374 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4375 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4376 case DW_TAG_string_type:
4377 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4378 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4379 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4380 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4381 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4382 case DW_TAG_typedef:
4383 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4384 case DW_TAG_union_type:
4385 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4386 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4387 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4388 case DW_TAG_variant:
4389 return "DW_TAG_variant";
4390 case DW_TAG_common_block:
4391 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4392 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4393 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4394 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4395 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4396 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4397 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4398 case DW_TAG_module:
4399 return "DW_TAG_module";
4400 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4401 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4402 case DW_TAG_set_type:
4403 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4404 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4405 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4406 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4407 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4408 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4409 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4410 case DW_TAG_base_type:
4411 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4412 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4413 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4414 case DW_TAG_const_type:
4415 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4416 case DW_TAG_constant:
4417 return "DW_TAG_constant";
4418 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4419 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4420 case DW_TAG_file_type:
4421 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4422 case DW_TAG_friend:
4423 return "DW_TAG_friend";
4424 case DW_TAG_namelist:
4425 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4426 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4427 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4428 case DW_TAG_namespace:
4429 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4430 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4431 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4432 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4433 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4434 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4435 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4436 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4437 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4438 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4439 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4440 case DW_TAG_try_block:
4441 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4442 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4443 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4444 case DW_TAG_variable:
4445 return "DW_TAG_variable";
4446 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4447 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4448 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4449 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4450 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4451 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4452 case DW_TAG_format_label:
4453 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4454 case DW_TAG_function_template:
4455 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4456 case DW_TAG_class_template:
4457 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4458 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4459 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4460 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4461 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4462 default:
4463 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4467 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4469 static const char *
4470 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4472 switch (attr)
4474 case DW_AT_sibling:
4475 return "DW_AT_sibling";
4476 case DW_AT_location:
4477 return "DW_AT_location";
4478 case DW_AT_name:
4479 return "DW_AT_name";
4480 case DW_AT_ordering:
4481 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4482 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4483 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4484 case DW_AT_byte_size:
4485 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4486 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4487 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4488 case DW_AT_bit_size:
4489 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4490 case DW_AT_element_list:
4491 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4492 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4493 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4494 case DW_AT_low_pc:
4495 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4496 case DW_AT_high_pc:
4497 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4498 case DW_AT_language:
4499 return "DW_AT_language";
4500 case DW_AT_member:
4501 return "DW_AT_member";
4502 case DW_AT_discr:
4503 return "DW_AT_discr";
4504 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4505 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4506 case DW_AT_visibility:
4507 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4508 case DW_AT_import:
4509 return "DW_AT_import";
4510 case DW_AT_string_length:
4511 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4512 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4513 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4514 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4515 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4516 case DW_AT_const_value:
4517 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4518 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4519 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4520 case DW_AT_default_value:
4521 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4522 case DW_AT_inline:
4523 return "DW_AT_inline";
4524 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4525 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4526 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4527 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4528 case DW_AT_producer:
4529 return "DW_AT_producer";
4530 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4531 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4532 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4533 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4534 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4535 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4536 case DW_AT_stride_size:
4537 return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4538 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4539 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4540 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4541 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4542 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4543 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4544 case DW_AT_address_class:
4545 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4546 case DW_AT_artificial:
4547 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4548 case DW_AT_base_types:
4549 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4550 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4551 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4552 case DW_AT_count:
4553 return "DW_AT_count";
4554 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4555 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4556 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4557 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4558 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4559 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4560 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4561 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4562 case DW_AT_declaration:
4563 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4564 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4565 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4566 case DW_AT_encoding:
4567 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4568 case DW_AT_external:
4569 return "DW_AT_external";
4570 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4571 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4572 case DW_AT_friend:
4573 return "DW_AT_friend";
4574 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4575 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4576 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4577 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4578 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4579 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4580 case DW_AT_priority:
4581 return "DW_AT_priority";
4582 case DW_AT_segment:
4583 return "DW_AT_segment";
4584 case DW_AT_specification:
4585 return "DW_AT_specification";
4586 case DW_AT_static_link:
4587 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4588 case DW_AT_type:
4589 return "DW_AT_type";
4590 case DW_AT_use_location:
4591 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4592 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4593 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4594 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4595 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4596 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4597 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4599 case DW_AT_allocated:
4600 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4601 case DW_AT_associated:
4602 return "DW_AT_associated";
4603 case DW_AT_data_location:
4604 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4605 case DW_AT_stride:
4606 return "DW_AT_stride";
4607 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4608 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4609 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4610 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4611 case DW_AT_extension:
4612 return "DW_AT_extension";
4613 case DW_AT_ranges:
4614 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4615 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4616 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4617 case DW_AT_call_column:
4618 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4619 case DW_AT_call_file:
4620 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4621 case DW_AT_call_line:
4622 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4624 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4625 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4626 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4627 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4628 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4629 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4630 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4631 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4632 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4633 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4634 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4635 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4636 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4637 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4638 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4639 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4640 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4641 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4642 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4643 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4644 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4645 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4647 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4648 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4649 case DW_AT_src_info:
4650 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4651 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4652 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4653 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4654 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4655 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4656 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4657 case DW_AT_body_end:
4658 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4659 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4660 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4662 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4663 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4665 default:
4666 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4670 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4672 static const char *
4673 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4675 switch (form)
4677 case DW_FORM_addr:
4678 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4679 case DW_FORM_block2:
4680 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4681 case DW_FORM_block4:
4682 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4683 case DW_FORM_data2:
4684 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4685 case DW_FORM_data4:
4686 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4687 case DW_FORM_data8:
4688 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4689 case DW_FORM_string:
4690 return "DW_FORM_string";
4691 case DW_FORM_block:
4692 return "DW_FORM_block";
4693 case DW_FORM_block1:
4694 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4695 case DW_FORM_data1:
4696 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4697 case DW_FORM_flag:
4698 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4699 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4700 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4701 case DW_FORM_strp:
4702 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4703 case DW_FORM_udata:
4704 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4705 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4706 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4707 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4708 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4709 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4710 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4711 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4712 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4713 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4714 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4715 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4716 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4717 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4718 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4719 default:
4720 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4724 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4725 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4726 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4727 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4728 given block. */
4730 static tree
4731 decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4733 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4734 return NULL_TREE;
4736 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4737 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4738 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4739 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4740 return NULL_TREE;
4742 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4743 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4744 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4746 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4749 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4750 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4751 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4752 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4753 given block. */
4755 static tree
4756 block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4758 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4760 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4761 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4762 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4763 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4764 return NULL_TREE;
4766 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4767 return NULL_TREE;
4768 else
4770 tree ret_val;
4771 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4775 ret_val = lookahead;
4776 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4777 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4779 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4781 /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4782 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
4783 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
4784 will give us if it has one). Note that DECL's abstract origins are
4785 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
4786 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins. */
4787 if (DECL_P (ret_val))
4788 return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
4790 return ret_val;
4794 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4795 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4796 parameter. */
4798 static tree
4799 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4801 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4803 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4804 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4805 else
4806 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4807 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4809 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4810 context = NULL_TREE;
4812 return context;
4815 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. We build the lists up in reverse
4816 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
4818 static inline void
4819 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4821 if (die != NULL && attr != NULL)
4823 attr->dw_attr_next = die->die_attr;
4824 die->die_attr = attr;
4828 static inline enum dw_val_class
4829 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4831 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4834 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4836 static inline void
4837 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4839 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4841 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4842 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4843 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4844 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4845 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4848 static inline unsigned
4849 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4851 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4852 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4855 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4857 static inline void
4858 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4860 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4862 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4863 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4864 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4865 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4866 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4869 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4870 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4872 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
4873 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4876 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4878 static inline void
4879 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4880 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4882 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4884 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4885 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4886 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4887 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4888 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4891 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4892 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4894 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
4895 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4898 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4900 static inline void
4901 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4902 long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4904 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4906 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4907 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4908 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4909 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4910 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4911 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4914 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4916 static inline void
4917 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4918 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4920 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4922 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4923 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4924 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4925 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4926 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4927 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4928 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4931 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4933 static hashval_t
4934 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
4936 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
4939 static int
4940 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
4942 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
4943 (const char *)x2) == 0;
4946 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4948 static inline void
4949 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4951 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4952 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4953 void **slot;
4955 if (! debug_str_hash)
4956 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
4957 debug_str_eq, NULL);
4959 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
4960 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4961 if (*slot == NULL)
4962 *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
4963 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
4964 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4965 node->refcount++;
4967 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4968 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4969 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4970 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4971 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4974 static inline const char *
4975 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
4977 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4978 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4981 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4982 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4984 static int
4985 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
4987 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4988 unsigned int len;
4989 char label[32];
4991 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4993 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
4994 if (node->form)
4995 return node->form;
4997 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4999 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5000 always better to put it inline. */
5001 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
5002 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5004 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5005 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5006 single module. */
5007 if ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
5008 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
5009 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5011 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
5012 ++dw2_string_counter;
5013 node->label = xstrdup (label);
5015 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
5018 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5020 static inline void
5021 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5023 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5025 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5026 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5027 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
5028 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
5029 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
5030 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5033 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5034 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
5036 static inline void
5037 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5039 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
5040 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
5041 targ_die->die_definition = die;
5044 static inline dw_die_ref
5045 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
5047 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5048 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
5051 static inline int
5052 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
5054 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5055 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
5057 return 0;
5060 static inline void
5061 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
5063 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5064 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
5067 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5069 static inline void
5070 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
5072 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5074 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5075 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5076 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
5077 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
5078 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5081 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
5083 static inline void
5084 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5086 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5088 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5089 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5090 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
5091 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
5092 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5095 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
5096 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
5098 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
5099 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
5102 static inline void
5103 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
5105 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5107 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5108 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5109 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5110 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5111 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5112 have_location_lists = true;
5115 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
5116 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5118 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5119 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5122 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
5124 static inline void
5125 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5127 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5129 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5130 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5131 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5132 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5133 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5136 static inline rtx
5137 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5139 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5140 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5143 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5145 static inline void
5146 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5148 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5150 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5151 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5152 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5153 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5154 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5157 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5159 static inline void
5160 add_AT_lbl_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *label)
5162 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5164 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5165 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5166 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_offset;
5167 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5168 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5171 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5173 static inline void
5174 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5175 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5177 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5179 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5180 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5181 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5182 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5183 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5186 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
5188 static void
5189 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5190 long unsigned int offset)
5192 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5194 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5195 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5196 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5197 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5198 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5201 static inline const char *
5202 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5204 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5205 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_offset));
5206 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5209 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5211 static dw_attr_ref
5212 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5214 dw_attr_ref a;
5215 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5217 if (die != NULL)
5219 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5220 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5221 return a;
5222 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5223 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5224 spec = AT_ref (a);
5226 if (spec)
5227 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5230 return NULL;
5233 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5234 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5235 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5237 static inline const char *
5238 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5240 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5242 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5245 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5246 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5247 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5249 static inline const char *
5250 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5252 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5254 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5257 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5258 NULL if it is not present. */
5260 static inline const char *
5261 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5263 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5265 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5268 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5269 if it is not present. */
5271 static inline int
5272 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5274 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5276 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5279 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5280 if it is not present. */
5282 static inline unsigned
5283 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5285 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5287 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5290 static inline dw_die_ref
5291 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5293 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5295 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5298 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
5300 static inline bool
5301 is_c_family (void)
5303 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5305 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89
5306 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
5309 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5311 static inline bool
5312 is_cxx (void)
5314 return (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
5315 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
5318 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5320 static inline bool
5321 is_fortran (void)
5323 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5325 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5326 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5327 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5330 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
5332 static inline bool
5333 is_java (void)
5335 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5337 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5340 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5342 static inline bool
5343 is_ada (void)
5345 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5347 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5350 /* Free up the memory used by A. */
5352 static inline void free_AT (dw_attr_ref);
5353 static inline void
5354 free_AT (dw_attr_ref a)
5356 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5357 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5358 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5361 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
5363 static void
5364 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5366 dw_attr_ref *p;
5367 dw_attr_ref removed = NULL;
5369 if (die != NULL)
5371 for (p = &(die->die_attr); *p; p = &((*p)->dw_attr_next))
5372 if ((*p)->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5374 removed = *p;
5375 *p = (*p)->dw_attr_next;
5376 break;
5379 if (removed != 0)
5380 free_AT (removed);
5384 /* Remove child die whose die_tag is specified tag. */
5386 static void
5387 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5389 dw_die_ref current, prev, next;
5390 current = die->die_child;
5391 prev = NULL;
5392 while (current != NULL)
5394 if (current->die_tag == tag)
5396 next = current->die_sib;
5397 if (prev == NULL)
5398 die->die_child = next;
5399 else
5400 prev->die_sib = next;
5401 free_die (current);
5402 current = next;
5404 else
5406 prev = current;
5407 current = current->die_sib;
5412 /* Free up the memory used by DIE. */
5414 static inline void
5415 free_die (dw_die_ref die)
5417 remove_children (die);
5420 /* Discard the children of this DIE. */
5422 static void
5423 remove_children (dw_die_ref die)
5425 dw_die_ref child_die = die->die_child;
5427 die->die_child = NULL;
5429 while (child_die != NULL)
5431 dw_die_ref tmp_die = child_die;
5432 dw_attr_ref a;
5434 child_die = child_die->die_sib;
5436 for (a = tmp_die->die_attr; a != NULL;)
5438 dw_attr_ref tmp_a = a;
5440 a = a->dw_attr_next;
5441 free_AT (tmp_a);
5444 free_die (tmp_die);
5448 /* Add a child DIE below its parent. We build the lists up in reverse
5449 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
5451 static inline void
5452 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5454 if (die != NULL && child_die != NULL)
5456 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5458 child_die->die_parent = die;
5459 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child;
5460 die->die_child = child_die;
5464 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5465 is the specification, to the front of PARENT's list of children. */
5467 static void
5468 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5470 dw_die_ref *p;
5472 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5473 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5474 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5476 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5478 if (tmp)
5479 child = tmp;
5482 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5483 || (child->die_parent
5484 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5486 for (p = &(child->die_parent->die_child); *p; p = &((*p)->die_sib))
5487 if (*p == child)
5489 *p = child->die_sib;
5490 break;
5493 child->die_parent = parent;
5494 child->die_sib = parent->die_child;
5495 parent->die_child = child;
5498 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5500 static inline dw_die_ref
5501 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5503 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5505 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5507 if (parent_die != NULL)
5508 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5509 else
5511 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5513 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5514 limbo_node->die = die;
5515 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5516 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5517 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5520 return die;
5523 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5525 static inline dw_die_ref
5526 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5528 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5531 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5533 static inline void
5534 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5536 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5539 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5541 static hashval_t
5542 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5544 return (hashval_t) ((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5547 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5549 static int
5550 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5552 return (((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5555 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5557 static inline dw_die_ref
5558 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5560 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5563 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5565 static hashval_t
5566 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5568 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5571 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5572 UID of decl *Y. */
5574 static int
5575 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5577 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5580 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5582 static inline var_loc_list *
5583 lookup_decl_loc (tree decl)
5585 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5588 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5590 static void
5591 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5593 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5594 void **slot;
5596 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5597 *slot = decl_die;
5598 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5601 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5603 static void
5604 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5606 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5607 var_loc_list *temp;
5608 void **slot;
5610 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5611 if (*slot == NULL)
5613 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5614 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5615 *slot = temp;
5617 else
5618 temp = *slot;
5620 if (temp->last)
5622 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5623 we have nothing to do. */
5624 if (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5625 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5627 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
5628 temp->last->next = loc;
5629 temp->last = loc;
5632 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
5633 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5635 temp->first = loc;
5636 temp->last = loc;
5640 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5641 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5642 the DIE internal representation. */
5643 static int print_indent;
5645 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5647 static inline void
5648 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5650 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5653 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5654 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5656 static void
5657 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5659 dw_attr_ref a;
5660 dw_die_ref c;
5662 print_spaces (outfile);
5663 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
5664 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5665 print_spaces (outfile);
5666 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5667 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
5669 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5671 print_spaces (outfile);
5672 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5674 switch (AT_class (a))
5676 case dw_val_class_addr:
5677 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5678 break;
5679 case dw_val_class_offset:
5680 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5681 break;
5682 case dw_val_class_loc:
5683 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5684 break;
5685 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5686 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5687 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5688 break;
5689 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5690 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5691 break;
5692 case dw_val_class_const:
5693 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5694 break;
5695 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5696 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5697 break;
5698 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5699 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5700 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5701 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5702 break;
5703 case dw_val_class_vec:
5704 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5705 break;
5706 case dw_val_class_flag:
5707 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5708 break;
5709 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5710 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5712 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5713 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5714 else
5715 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5717 else
5718 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5719 break;
5720 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5721 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5722 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5723 break;
5724 case dw_val_class_str:
5725 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5726 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5727 else
5728 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5729 break;
5730 default:
5731 break;
5734 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5737 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5739 print_indent += 4;
5740 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5741 print_die (c, outfile);
5743 print_indent -= 4;
5745 if (print_indent == 0)
5746 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5749 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5750 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5752 static void
5753 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5755 unsigned i;
5756 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5758 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5759 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5761 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5762 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: ", i);
5763 fprintf (outfile, "%-20s",
5764 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, line_info->dw_file_num));
5765 fprintf (outfile, "%6ld", line_info->dw_line_num);
5766 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5769 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5772 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5774 void
5775 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5777 print_die (die, stderr);
5780 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5781 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5783 void
5784 debug_dwarf (void)
5786 print_indent = 0;
5787 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5788 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5789 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5792 /* We build up the lists of children and attributes by pushing new ones
5793 onto the beginning of the list. Reverse the lists for DIE so that
5794 they are in order of addition. */
5796 static void
5797 reverse_die_lists (dw_die_ref die)
5799 dw_die_ref c, cp, cn;
5800 dw_attr_ref a, ap, an;
5802 for (a = die->die_attr, ap = 0; a; a = an)
5804 an = a->dw_attr_next;
5805 a->dw_attr_next = ap;
5806 ap = a;
5809 die->die_attr = ap;
5811 for (c = die->die_child, cp = 0; c; c = cn)
5813 cn = c->die_sib;
5814 c->die_sib = cp;
5815 cp = c;
5818 die->die_child = cp;
5821 /* reverse_die_lists only reverses the single die you pass it. Since we used to
5822 reverse all dies in add_sibling_attributes, which runs through all the dies,
5823 it would reverse all the dies. Now, however, since we don't call
5824 reverse_die_lists in add_sibling_attributes, we need a routine to
5825 recursively reverse all the dies. This is that routine. */
5827 static void
5828 reverse_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
5830 dw_die_ref c;
5832 reverse_die_lists (die);
5834 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5835 reverse_all_dies (c);
5838 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5839 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5840 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5842 static dw_die_ref
5843 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5845 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5846 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5848 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5849 return new_unit;
5852 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5854 static dw_die_ref
5855 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5857 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5859 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5860 return new_unit;
5863 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5864 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5866 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5868 static inline void
5869 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5871 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5872 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5873 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5876 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5878 static void
5879 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5881 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5882 rtx r;
5884 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5886 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
5887 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
5888 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
5889 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5890 || at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5891 return;
5893 switch (AT_class (at))
5895 case dw_val_class_const:
5896 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5897 break;
5898 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5899 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5900 break;
5901 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5902 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5903 break;
5904 case dw_val_class_vec:
5905 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5906 break;
5907 case dw_val_class_flag:
5908 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5909 break;
5910 case dw_val_class_str:
5911 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5912 break;
5914 case dw_val_class_addr:
5915 r = AT_addr (at);
5916 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5917 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5918 break;
5920 case dw_val_class_offset:
5921 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5922 break;
5924 case dw_val_class_loc:
5925 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5926 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5927 break;
5929 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5930 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5931 break;
5933 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5934 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5935 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5936 break;
5938 default:
5939 break;
5943 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5945 static void
5946 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5948 dw_die_ref c;
5949 dw_attr_ref a;
5951 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5952 if (die->die_mark)
5954 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5955 return;
5957 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5959 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
5961 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5962 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
5964 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5965 die_checksum (c, ctx, mark);
5968 #undef CHECKSUM
5969 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5971 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
5972 static inline int
5973 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
5975 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
5976 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
5977 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
5980 /* Do the values look the same? */
5981 static int
5982 same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
5984 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
5985 rtx r1, r2;
5987 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
5988 return 0;
5990 switch (v1->val_class)
5992 case dw_val_class_const:
5993 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
5994 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5995 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
5996 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5997 return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
5998 && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
5999 case dw_val_class_vec:
6000 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6001 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6002 return 0;
6003 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6004 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6005 return 0;
6006 return 1;
6007 case dw_val_class_flag:
6008 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6009 case dw_val_class_str:
6010 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6012 case dw_val_class_addr:
6013 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6014 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6015 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6016 return 0;
6017 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
6018 return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
6020 case dw_val_class_offset:
6021 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6023 case dw_val_class_loc:
6024 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6025 loc1 && loc2;
6026 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6027 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6028 return 0;
6029 return !loc1 && !loc2;
6031 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6032 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6034 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6035 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6036 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6037 return 1;
6039 default:
6040 return 1;
6044 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6046 static int
6047 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6049 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6050 return 0;
6052 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
6053 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
6054 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
6055 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6056 || at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6057 return 1;
6059 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6062 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6064 static int
6065 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6067 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6068 dw_attr_ref a1, a2;
6070 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6071 if (die1->die_mark)
6072 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6073 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6075 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6076 return 0;
6078 for (a1 = die1->die_attr, a2 = die2->die_attr;
6079 a1 && a2;
6080 a1 = a1->dw_attr_next, a2 = a2->dw_attr_next)
6081 if (!same_attr_p (a1, a2, mark))
6082 return 0;
6083 if (a1 || a2)
6084 return 0;
6086 for (c1 = die1->die_child, c2 = die2->die_child;
6087 c1 && c2;
6088 c1 = c1->die_sib, c2 = c2->die_sib)
6089 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6090 return 0;
6091 if (c1 || c2)
6092 return 0;
6094 return 1;
6097 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6099 static int
6100 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6102 int mark = 0;
6103 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6105 unmark_all_dies (die1);
6106 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6108 return ret;
6111 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6112 info section. */
6113 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6115 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6116 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6118 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6119 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6121 static void
6122 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6124 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6125 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6126 char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6127 char *p;
6128 int i, mark;
6129 unsigned char checksum[16];
6130 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6132 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6133 the name filename of the unit. */
6135 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6136 mark = 0;
6137 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6138 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6139 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6141 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6142 clean_symbol_name (name);
6144 p = name + strlen (name);
6145 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6147 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6148 p += 2;
6151 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6152 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6155 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6157 static int
6158 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6160 switch (die->die_tag)
6162 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6163 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6164 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6165 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6166 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6167 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6168 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6169 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6170 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6171 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6172 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6173 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6174 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6175 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6176 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6177 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6178 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6179 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6180 return 1;
6181 default:
6182 return 0;
6186 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6187 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6188 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6189 compilations (functions). */
6191 static int
6192 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6194 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6195 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6196 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6197 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6199 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6200 return 0;
6202 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6203 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6204 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6205 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6207 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6209 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6212 return is_type_die (c);
6215 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6216 compilation unit. */
6218 static int
6219 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6221 return (is_type_die (c)
6222 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6223 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification)));
6226 static char *
6227 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6229 char buf[256];
6231 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6232 return xstrdup (buf);
6235 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6237 static void
6238 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6240 dw_die_ref c;
6242 if (is_symbol_die (die))
6244 if (comdat_symbol_id)
6246 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6248 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6249 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6250 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6252 else
6253 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6256 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6257 assign_symbol_names (c);
6260 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6262 dw_die_ref cu;
6263 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6264 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6267 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6268 static hashval_t
6269 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6271 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6273 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6276 static int
6277 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6279 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6280 const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6282 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6285 static void
6286 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6288 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6290 while (entry)
6292 next = entry->next;
6293 free (entry);
6294 entry = next;
6298 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6299 accordingly. */
6300 static int
6301 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6303 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6304 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6306 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6308 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6309 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6310 INSERT);
6311 entry = *slot;
6313 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6315 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6316 break;
6319 if (entry)
6321 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6322 return 1;
6325 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6326 entry->cu = cu;
6327 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6328 entry->next = *slot;
6329 *slot = entry;
6331 return 0;
6334 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6335 static void
6336 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6338 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6340 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6341 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6342 NO_INSERT);
6343 entry = *slot;
6345 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6348 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6349 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6350 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6352 static void
6353 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6355 dw_die_ref *ptr;
6356 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6357 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6358 htab_t cu_hash_table;
6360 for (ptr = &(die->die_child); *ptr;)
6362 dw_die_ref c = *ptr;
6364 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6365 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6367 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6368 *ptr = c->die_sib;
6370 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6372 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6373 free_die (c);
6375 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6377 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6378 free_die (c);
6380 else
6381 add_child_die (unit, c);
6383 else
6385 /* Leave this DIE in the main CU. */
6386 ptr = &(c->die_sib);
6387 continue;
6391 #if 0
6392 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6393 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6394 gcc_assert (!unit);
6395 #endif
6397 assign_symbol_names (die);
6398 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6399 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6400 node;
6401 node = node->next)
6403 int is_dupl;
6405 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6406 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6407 &comdat_symbol_number);
6408 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6409 if (is_dupl)
6410 *pnode = node->next;
6411 else
6413 pnode = &node->next;
6414 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6415 comdat_symbol_number);
6418 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6421 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6422 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
6423 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
6425 static void
6426 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6428 dw_die_ref c;
6430 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
6431 && die->die_sib && die->die_child != NULL)
6432 /* Add the sibling link to the front of the attribute list. */
6433 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6435 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6436 add_sibling_attributes (c);
6439 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
6441 static void
6442 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6444 dw_die_ref c;
6445 dw_attr_ref d_attr;
6447 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
6448 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6449 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (d_attr));
6451 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6452 output_location_lists (c);
6456 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6457 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6458 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
6459 die are visited recursively. */
6461 static void
6462 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6464 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6465 unsigned int n_alloc;
6466 dw_die_ref c;
6467 dw_attr_ref d_attr, a_attr;
6469 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6470 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6471 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
6472 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6473 && AT_ref (d_attr)->die_mark == 0)
6475 gcc_assert (AT_ref (d_attr)->die_symbol);
6477 set_AT_ref_external (d_attr, 1);
6480 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6482 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6484 if (abbrev->die_tag == die->die_tag)
6486 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) == (die->die_child != NULL))
6488 a_attr = abbrev->die_attr;
6489 d_attr = die->die_attr;
6491 while (a_attr != NULL && d_attr != NULL)
6493 if ((a_attr->dw_attr != d_attr->dw_attr)
6494 || (value_format (a_attr) != value_format (d_attr)))
6495 break;
6497 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next;
6498 d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next;
6501 if (a_attr == NULL && d_attr == NULL)
6502 break;
6507 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6509 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6511 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6512 abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6513 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6515 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6516 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6517 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6520 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6521 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6524 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6525 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6526 build_abbrev_table (c);
6529 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
6531 static int
6532 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6534 int log;
6536 if (value == 0)
6537 log = 0;
6538 else
6539 log = floor_log2 (value);
6541 log = log / 8;
6542 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6544 return log;
6547 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6548 .debug_info section. */
6550 static unsigned long
6551 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6553 unsigned long size = 0;
6554 dw_attr_ref a;
6556 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6557 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6559 switch (AT_class (a))
6561 case dw_val_class_addr:
6562 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6563 break;
6564 case dw_val_class_offset:
6565 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6566 break;
6567 case dw_val_class_loc:
6569 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6571 /* Block length. */
6572 size += constant_size (lsize);
6573 size += lsize;
6575 break;
6576 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6577 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6578 break;
6579 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6580 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6581 break;
6582 case dw_val_class_const:
6583 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6584 break;
6585 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6586 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6587 break;
6588 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6589 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6590 break;
6591 case dw_val_class_vec:
6592 size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6593 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6594 break;
6595 case dw_val_class_flag:
6596 size += 1;
6597 break;
6598 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6599 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6600 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6601 else
6602 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6603 break;
6604 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6605 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6606 break;
6607 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6608 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6609 break;
6610 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6611 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6612 break;
6613 case dw_val_class_str:
6614 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6615 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6616 else
6617 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6618 break;
6619 default:
6620 gcc_unreachable ();
6624 return size;
6627 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
6628 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6629 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6630 die_offset field in each DIE. */
6632 static void
6633 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6635 dw_die_ref c;
6637 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6638 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6640 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6641 calc_die_sizes (c);
6643 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6644 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
6645 next_die_offset += 1;
6648 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
6649 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6650 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
6651 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
6653 static void
6654 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6656 dw_die_ref c;
6658 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6660 die->die_mark = 1;
6661 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6662 mark_dies (c);
6665 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
6667 static void
6668 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6670 dw_die_ref c;
6672 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6674 die->die_mark = 0;
6675 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6676 unmark_dies (c);
6679 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
6681 static void
6682 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6684 dw_die_ref c;
6685 dw_attr_ref a;
6687 if (!die->die_mark)
6688 return;
6689 die->die_mark = 0;
6691 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6692 unmark_all_dies (c);
6694 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6695 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6696 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6699 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames table generated for the
6700 compilation unit. */
6702 static unsigned long
6703 size_of_pubnames (void)
6705 unsigned long size;
6706 unsigned i;
6708 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6709 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6711 pubname_ref p = &pubname_table[i];
6712 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + strlen (p->name) + 1;
6715 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6716 return size;
6719 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6721 static unsigned long
6722 size_of_aranges (void)
6724 unsigned long size;
6726 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6728 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6729 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6730 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6732 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6733 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6734 return size;
6737 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6739 static enum dwarf_form
6740 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6742 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6744 case dw_val_class_addr:
6745 return DW_FORM_addr;
6746 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6747 case dw_val_class_offset:
6748 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6750 case 4:
6751 return DW_FORM_data4;
6752 case 8:
6753 return DW_FORM_data8;
6754 default:
6755 gcc_unreachable ();
6757 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6758 /* FIXME: Could be DW_FORM_data8, with a > 32 bit size
6759 .debug_loc section */
6760 return DW_FORM_data4;
6761 case dw_val_class_loc:
6762 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6764 case 1:
6765 return DW_FORM_block1;
6766 case 2:
6767 return DW_FORM_block2;
6768 default:
6769 gcc_unreachable ();
6771 case dw_val_class_const:
6772 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6773 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6774 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6776 case 1:
6777 return DW_FORM_data1;
6778 case 2:
6779 return DW_FORM_data2;
6780 case 4:
6781 return DW_FORM_data4;
6782 case 8:
6783 return DW_FORM_data8;
6784 default:
6785 gcc_unreachable ();
6787 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6788 return DW_FORM_block1;
6789 case dw_val_class_vec:
6790 return DW_FORM_block1;
6791 case dw_val_class_flag:
6792 return DW_FORM_flag;
6793 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6794 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6795 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6796 else
6797 return DW_FORM_ref;
6798 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6799 return DW_FORM_data;
6800 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6801 return DW_FORM_addr;
6802 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6803 return DW_FORM_data;
6804 case dw_val_class_str:
6805 return AT_string_form (a);
6807 default:
6808 gcc_unreachable ();
6812 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
6814 static void
6815 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6817 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6819 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6822 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6823 table. */
6825 static void
6826 output_abbrev_section (void)
6828 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6830 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6832 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6834 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6836 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6837 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6838 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6840 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6841 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6842 else
6843 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6845 for (a_attr = abbrev->die_attr; a_attr != NULL;
6846 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next)
6848 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6849 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6850 output_value_format (a_attr);
6853 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6854 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6857 /* Terminate the table. */
6858 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6861 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
6863 static inline void
6864 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6866 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6868 if (sym == 0)
6869 return;
6871 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6872 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6873 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6874 will break. */
6875 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
6877 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6880 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6881 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6882 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
6884 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
6885 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6886 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6888 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6890 retlist->begin = begin;
6891 retlist->end = end;
6892 retlist->expr = expr;
6893 retlist->section = section;
6894 if (gensym)
6895 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6897 return retlist;
6900 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
6902 static inline void
6903 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6904 const char *begin, const char *end,
6905 const char *section)
6907 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6909 /* Find the end of the chain. */
6910 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6913 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
6914 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6917 static void
6918 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
6920 dw_fde_ref fde;
6922 gcc_assert (cfun);
6924 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
6925 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
6926 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = cfun->hot_section_label;
6927 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = cfun->hot_section_end_label;
6928 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
6929 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = cfun->cold_section_end_label;
6930 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
6933 /* Output the location list given to us. */
6935 static void
6936 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
6938 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
6940 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
6942 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
6943 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
6945 unsigned long size;
6946 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
6948 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
6949 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6950 list_head->ll_symbol);
6951 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
6952 "Location list end address (%s)",
6953 list_head->ll_symbol);
6955 else
6957 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
6958 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6959 list_head->ll_symbol);
6960 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
6961 "Location list end address (%s)",
6962 list_head->ll_symbol);
6964 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
6966 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6967 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
6968 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
6970 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
6973 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
6974 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
6975 list_head->ll_symbol);
6976 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
6977 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
6978 list_head->ll_symbol);
6981 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
6982 the definitions of each child DIE. */
6984 static void
6985 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
6987 dw_attr_ref a;
6988 dw_die_ref c;
6989 unsigned long size;
6991 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
6992 them to point to. */
6993 if (die->die_symbol)
6994 output_die_symbol (die);
6996 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
6997 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
6999 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
7001 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7003 switch (AT_class (a))
7005 case dw_val_class_addr:
7006 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7007 break;
7009 case dw_val_class_offset:
7010 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7011 "%s", name);
7012 break;
7014 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7016 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7018 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7019 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7020 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7021 "%s", name);
7022 *p = '\0';
7024 break;
7026 case dw_val_class_loc:
7027 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7029 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7030 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7032 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
7033 break;
7035 case dw_val_class_const:
7036 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7037 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7038 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
7039 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7040 break;
7042 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7043 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
7044 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7045 break;
7047 case dw_val_class_long_long:
7049 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7051 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7052 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7053 "%s", name);
7055 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7057 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7058 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7060 else
7062 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7063 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7066 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7067 first, "long long constant");
7068 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7069 second, NULL);
7071 break;
7073 case dw_val_class_vec:
7075 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7076 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7077 unsigned int i;
7078 unsigned char *p;
7080 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7081 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7083 elt_size /= 2;
7084 len *= 2;
7086 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7087 i < len;
7088 i++, p += elt_size)
7089 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7090 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7091 break;
7094 case dw_val_class_flag:
7095 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7096 break;
7098 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7100 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7102 gcc_assert (sym);
7103 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, "%s", name);
7105 break;
7107 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7108 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7110 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7112 gcc_assert (sym);
7113 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, "%s", name);
7115 else
7117 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7118 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7119 "%s", name);
7121 break;
7123 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7125 char l1[20];
7127 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7128 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7129 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, "%s", name);
7131 break;
7133 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7134 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7135 break;
7137 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
7138 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7139 break;
7141 case dw_val_class_str:
7142 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7143 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7144 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7145 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7146 else
7147 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7148 break;
7150 default:
7151 gcc_unreachable ();
7155 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
7156 output_die (c);
7158 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
7159 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7160 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7161 die->die_offset);
7164 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7165 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
7167 static void
7168 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7170 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7171 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7172 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7173 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7174 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7175 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7176 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7177 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7178 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7179 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7182 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
7184 static void
7185 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7187 const char *secname;
7188 char *oldsym, *tmp;
7190 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
7191 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7192 return;
7194 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7195 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7196 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7197 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
7198 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
7199 mark_dies (die);
7201 build_abbrev_table (die);
7203 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
7204 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7205 calc_die_sizes (die);
7207 oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7208 if (oldsym)
7210 tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7212 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7213 secname = tmp;
7214 die->die_symbol = NULL;
7215 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
7217 else
7218 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
7220 /* Output debugging information. */
7221 output_compilation_unit_header ();
7222 output_die (die);
7224 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7225 output_pubnames. */
7226 if (oldsym)
7228 unmark_dies (die);
7229 die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7233 /* The DWARF2 pubname for a nested thingy looks like "A::f". The
7234 output of lang_hooks.decl_printable_name for C++ looks like
7235 "A::f(int)". Let's drop the argument list, and maybe the scope. */
7237 static const char *
7238 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7240 return lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7243 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
7245 static void
7246 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7248 pubname_ref p;
7250 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7251 return;
7253 if (pubname_table_in_use == pubname_table_allocated)
7255 pubname_table_allocated += PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7256 pubname_table
7257 = ggc_realloc (pubname_table,
7258 (pubname_table_allocated * sizeof (pubname_entry)));
7259 memset (pubname_table + pubname_table_in_use, 0,
7260 PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (pubname_entry));
7263 p = &pubname_table[pubname_table_in_use++];
7264 p->die = die;
7265 p->name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7268 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7269 visible names. For now, only generate entries for externally
7270 visible procedures. */
7272 static void
7273 output_pubnames (void)
7275 unsigned i;
7276 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames ();
7278 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7279 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7280 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7281 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7282 "Length of Public Names Info");
7283 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7284 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7285 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7286 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7287 "Compilation Unit Length");
7289 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
7291 pubname_ref pub = &pubname_table[i];
7293 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7294 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7296 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7297 "DIE offset");
7299 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7302 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7305 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
7307 static void
7308 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7310 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7311 return;
7313 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7315 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7316 arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7317 (arange_table_allocated
7318 * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7319 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7320 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7323 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7326 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7327 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7328 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
7330 static void
7331 output_aranges (void)
7333 unsigned i;
7334 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7336 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7337 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7338 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7339 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7340 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7341 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7342 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7343 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7344 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7345 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7347 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
7348 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7350 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7351 pointer size. */
7352 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7353 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7354 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7355 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7358 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7359 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7360 text_section_label, "Length");
7361 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
7363 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7364 "Address");
7365 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7366 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7369 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7371 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7373 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7374 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7376 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7378 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7379 "Address");
7380 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7381 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7383 else
7385 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7386 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7387 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
7388 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7389 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7391 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7393 loc = AT_loc (a);
7394 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7396 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7397 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7398 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7399 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7400 "Length");
7404 /* Output the terminator words. */
7405 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7406 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7409 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
7410 was placed. */
7412 static unsigned int
7413 add_ranges (tree block)
7415 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7417 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7419 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7420 ranges_table
7421 = ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7422 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7423 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7424 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7427 ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7428 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7430 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7433 static void
7434 output_ranges (void)
7436 unsigned i;
7437 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7438 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7440 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7442 int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
7444 if (block_num)
7446 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7447 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7449 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7450 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7452 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7453 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7454 base of the text section. */
7455 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7457 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7458 text_section_label,
7459 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7460 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7461 text_section_label, NULL);
7464 /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
7465 compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
7466 use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
7467 target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
7468 else
7470 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7471 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7472 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7475 fmt = NULL;
7477 else
7479 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7480 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7481 fmt = start_fmt;
7486 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
7487 struct file_info
7489 char *path; /* Complete file name. */
7490 char *fname; /* File name part. */
7491 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
7492 int file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
7493 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
7496 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7497 files. */
7498 struct dir_info
7500 char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
7501 int length; /* Path length. */
7502 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
7503 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
7504 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
7505 int used; /* Used in the end? */
7508 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
7509 the directories in the path. */
7511 static int
7512 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7514 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7515 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7516 unsigned char *cp1;
7517 unsigned char *cp2;
7519 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
7520 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7521 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7522 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7523 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
7524 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7525 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7527 cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7528 cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7530 while (1)
7532 ++cp1;
7533 ++cp2;
7534 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
7535 if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7536 || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7537 return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7538 - (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7540 /* Character of current path component the same? */
7541 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7542 return *cp1 - *cp2;
7546 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
7547 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
7548 slowdowns with many input files. */
7550 static void
7551 output_file_names (void)
7553 struct file_info *files;
7554 struct dir_info *dirs;
7555 int *saved;
7556 int *savehere;
7557 int *backmap;
7558 size_t ndirs;
7559 int idx_offset;
7560 size_t i;
7561 int idx;
7563 /* Handle the case where file_table is empty. */
7564 if (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) <= 1)
7566 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7567 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7568 return;
7571 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
7572 files = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct file_info));
7573 dirs = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7575 /* Sort the file names. */
7576 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7578 char *f;
7580 /* Skip all leading "./". */
7581 f = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i);
7582 while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
7583 f += 2;
7585 /* Create a new array entry. */
7586 files[i].path = f;
7587 files[i].length = strlen (f);
7588 files[i].file_idx = i;
7590 /* Search for the file name part. */
7591 f = strrchr (f, '/');
7592 files[i].fname = f == NULL ? files[i].path : f + 1;
7595 qsort (files + 1, VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) - 1,
7596 sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7598 /* Find all the different directories used. */
7599 dirs[0].path = files[1].path;
7600 dirs[0].length = files[1].fname - files[1].path;
7601 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7602 dirs[0].count = 1;
7603 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7604 dirs[0].used = 0;
7605 files[1].dir_idx = 0;
7606 ndirs = 1;
7608 for (i = 2; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7609 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7610 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7611 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7613 /* Same directory as last entry. */
7614 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7615 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7617 else
7619 size_t j;
7621 /* This is a new directory. */
7622 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7623 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7624 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7625 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7626 dirs[ndirs].used = 0;
7627 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7629 /* Search for a prefix. */
7630 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7631 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7632 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7633 && dirs[j].length > 1
7634 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7635 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7636 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7637 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7639 ++ndirs;
7642 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
7643 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7644 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
7645 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7646 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7647 results in most cases and never is much off. */
7648 saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7649 savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7651 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7652 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7654 size_t j;
7655 int total;
7657 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
7658 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
7659 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7660 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7662 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7664 savehere[j] = 0;
7665 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7667 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7668 dirs[j] path. */
7669 int k;
7671 k = dirs[j].prefix;
7672 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7673 k = dirs[k].prefix;
7675 if (k == (int) i)
7677 /* Yes it is. We can possibly safe some memory but
7678 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7679 dirs[i]. */
7680 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7681 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7686 /* Check whether we can safe enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7687 directory. */
7688 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7690 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
7691 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7692 if (savehere[j] > 0)
7694 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
7695 saved[j] = savehere[j];
7697 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
7698 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7703 /* We have to emit them in the order they appear in the file_table array
7704 since the index is used in the debug info generation. To do this
7705 efficiently we generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
7706 backmap = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (int));
7707 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7709 backmap[files[i].file_idx] = i;
7711 /* Mark this directory as used. */
7712 dirs[dirs[files[i].dir_idx].dir_idx].used = 1;
7715 /* That was it. We are ready to emit the information. First emit the
7716 directory name table. We have to make sure the first actually emitted
7717 directory name has index one; zero is reserved for the current working
7718 directory. Make sure we do not confuse these indices with the one for the
7719 constructed table (even though most of the time they are identical). */
7720 idx = 1;
7721 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7722 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7723 if (dirs[i].used != 0)
7725 dirs[i].used = idx++;
7726 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7727 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", dirs[i].used);
7730 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7732 /* Correct the index for the current working directory entry if it
7733 exists. */
7734 if (idx_offset == 0)
7735 dirs[0].used = 0;
7737 /* Now write all the file names. */
7738 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7740 int file_idx = backmap[i];
7741 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7743 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7744 "File Entry: 0x%lx", (unsigned long) i);
7746 /* Include directory index. */
7747 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dirs[dir_idx].used, NULL);
7749 /* Modification time. */
7750 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7752 /* File length in bytes. */
7753 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7756 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7760 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
7761 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
7763 static void
7764 output_line_info (void)
7766 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7767 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7768 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7769 unsigned opc;
7770 unsigned n_op_args;
7771 unsigned long lt_index;
7772 unsigned long current_line;
7773 long line_offset;
7774 long line_delta;
7775 unsigned long current_file;
7776 unsigned long function;
7778 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7779 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7780 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7781 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7783 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7784 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7785 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7786 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7787 "Length of Source Line Info");
7788 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7790 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7791 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7792 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7794 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7795 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7796 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
7797 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7798 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7799 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7800 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7801 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
7802 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7803 "Minimum Instruction Length");
7805 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7806 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7807 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7808 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7809 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7810 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7811 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7812 "Special Opcode Base");
7814 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7816 switch (opc)
7818 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7819 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7820 case DW_LNS_set_file:
7821 case DW_LNS_set_column:
7822 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7823 n_op_args = 1;
7824 break;
7825 default:
7826 n_op_args = 0;
7827 break;
7830 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7831 opc, n_op_args);
7834 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
7835 output_file_names ();
7836 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7838 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7839 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7840 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
7842 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7843 a series of state machine operations. */
7844 current_file = 1;
7845 current_line = 1;
7847 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
7848 strcpy (prev_line_label, cfun->cold_section_label);
7849 else
7850 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7851 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7853 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7855 #if 0
7856 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7857 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7858 prologue. */
7860 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
7861 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7862 that anything after the last address is this line. */
7863 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7864 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
7865 continue;
7866 #endif
7868 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
7870 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
7871 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
7872 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
7873 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
7874 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
7875 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
7877 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
7878 if (0)
7880 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
7881 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7882 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7883 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7885 else
7887 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
7888 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
7889 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7890 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7891 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7892 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7895 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7897 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7898 different from the previous line. */
7899 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7901 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7902 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7903 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7904 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
7905 current_file));
7908 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7909 that uses the least amount of space. */
7910 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7912 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7913 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7914 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7915 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7916 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
7917 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
7918 takes 1 byte. */
7919 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7920 "line %lu", current_line);
7921 else
7923 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
7924 depending on the value being encoded. */
7925 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7926 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7927 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7928 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7931 else
7932 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
7933 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7936 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7937 if (0)
7939 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7940 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7941 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7943 else
7945 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7946 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7947 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7948 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
7951 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7952 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7953 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7955 function = 0;
7956 current_file = 1;
7957 current_line = 1;
7958 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
7960 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
7961 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
7963 #if 0
7964 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
7965 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7966 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
7967 && line_info->function == function)
7968 goto cont;
7969 #endif
7971 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
7972 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
7973 to handle it differently. */
7974 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
7975 lt_index);
7976 if (function != line_info->function)
7978 function = line_info->function;
7980 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
7981 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7982 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7983 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7984 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7986 else
7988 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
7989 if (0)
7991 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7992 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7993 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7995 else
7997 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7998 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7999 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8000 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8004 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8006 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8007 different from the previous line. */
8008 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8010 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8011 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8012 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
8013 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
8014 current_file));
8017 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8018 that uses the least amount of space. */
8019 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8021 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8022 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8023 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8024 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8025 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8026 "line %lu", current_line);
8027 else
8029 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8030 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8031 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8032 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8035 else
8036 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8038 #if 0
8039 cont:
8040 #endif
8042 lt_index++;
8044 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
8045 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
8046 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
8048 current_file = 1;
8049 current_line = 1;
8051 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8052 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
8053 if (0)
8055 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8056 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8057 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8059 else
8061 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8062 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8063 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8064 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8067 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
8068 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8069 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8070 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8074 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
8075 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
8078 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8079 a DIE that describes the given type.
8081 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8082 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
8084 static dw_die_ref
8085 base_type_die (tree type)
8087 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
8088 enum dwarf_type encoding;
8090 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
8091 return 0;
8093 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8095 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8096 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
8098 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8099 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8100 else
8101 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8103 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8104 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8105 else
8106 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8107 break;
8109 case REAL_TYPE:
8110 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8111 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
8112 else
8113 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8114 break;
8116 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8117 a user defined type for it. */
8118 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8119 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8120 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8121 else
8122 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8123 break;
8125 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8126 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
8127 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8128 break;
8130 default:
8131 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
8132 gcc_unreachable ();
8135 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8137 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
8138 if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
8139 add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
8141 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8142 int_size_in_bytes (type));
8143 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8145 return base_type_result;
8148 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
8149 the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type. The Dwarf "root" type of
8150 a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
8151 given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
8152 type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
8153 type. (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
8154 type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
8155 root type of the given type without the qualifiers. */
8157 static tree
8158 root_type (tree type)
8160 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8161 return error_mark_node;
8163 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8165 case ERROR_MARK:
8166 return error_mark_node;
8168 case POINTER_TYPE:
8169 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8170 return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
8172 default:
8173 return type_main_variant (type);
8177 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8178 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
8180 static inline int
8181 is_base_type (tree type)
8183 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8185 case ERROR_MARK:
8186 case VOID_TYPE:
8187 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8188 case REAL_TYPE:
8189 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8190 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8191 return 1;
8193 case ARRAY_TYPE:
8194 case RECORD_TYPE:
8195 case UNION_TYPE:
8196 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8197 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8198 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8199 case METHOD_TYPE:
8200 case POINTER_TYPE:
8201 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8202 case OFFSET_TYPE:
8203 case LANG_TYPE:
8204 case VECTOR_TYPE:
8205 return 0;
8207 default:
8208 gcc_unreachable ();
8211 return 0;
8214 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8215 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8216 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8217 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8218 ERROR_MARK node. */
8220 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8221 simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
8223 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8224 return BITS_PER_WORD;
8225 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8226 return 0;
8227 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8228 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8229 else
8230 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8233 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8234 emitted as a subrange type. */
8236 static inline bool
8237 is_subrange_type (tree type)
8239 tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8241 /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8242 types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8243 or an enumeral type. */
8245 if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8246 || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8247 return false;
8249 if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8250 && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8251 return false;
8253 if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8254 && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8255 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8256 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8257 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8258 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8259 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8260 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8262 /* The type and its subtype have the same representation. If in
8263 addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8264 type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type. */
8265 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8266 Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized. It should
8267 therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8268 rather than checking the actual size. Unfortunately, we have
8269 found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8270 this is not the case. Until this problem is solved, we need to
8271 keep checking the actual size. */
8272 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8273 tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8275 if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8276 type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8278 if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8279 subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8281 if (type_name == subtype_name)
8282 return false;
8285 return true;
8288 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8289 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
8291 static dw_die_ref
8292 subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8294 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8295 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8297 if (context_die == NULL)
8298 context_die = comp_unit_die;
8300 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8302 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
8304 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8305 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
8306 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8309 if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8310 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8311 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8312 if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8313 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8314 TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8316 return subrange_die;
8319 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8320 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
8322 static dw_die_ref
8323 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8324 dw_die_ref context_die)
8326 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8327 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
8328 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8329 tree item_type = NULL;
8330 tree qualified_type;
8331 tree name;
8333 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
8334 return NULL;
8336 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8337 this type. */
8338 qualified_type
8339 = get_qualified_type (type,
8340 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8341 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8343 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
8344 if (qualified_type)
8346 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8347 if (mod_type_die)
8348 return mod_type_die;
8351 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
8353 /* Handle C typedef types. */
8354 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
8356 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
8358 if (qualified_type == dtype)
8360 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
8361 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8362 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8364 else if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
8365 && (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8366 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)))
8367 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
8368 type to which it refers. */
8369 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
8370 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8371 context_die);
8372 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
8375 if (is_const_type)
8377 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8378 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8380 else if (is_volatile_type)
8382 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8383 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8385 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
8387 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8388 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8389 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8390 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8392 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8394 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8395 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8396 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8397 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8399 else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8401 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8402 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8404 else if (is_base_type (type))
8405 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8406 else
8408 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8410 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8411 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8412 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8413 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8414 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8415 ..._TYPE node. */
8416 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8417 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8418 else
8419 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8420 not the main variant. */
8421 return lookup_type_die (type);
8424 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
8425 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8426 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type. */
8427 if (name
8428 && (TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL || TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type))
8430 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8431 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8432 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8433 useful source coordinates anyway. */
8434 name = DECL_NAME (name);
8435 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8438 if (qualified_type)
8439 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
8441 if (item_type)
8442 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8443 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
8444 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
8445 types are possible in Ada. */
8446 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8447 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8448 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8449 context_die);
8451 if (sub_die != NULL)
8452 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8454 return mod_type_die;
8457 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8458 an enumerated type. */
8460 static inline int
8461 type_is_enum (tree type)
8463 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8466 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
8468 static unsigned int
8469 dbx_reg_number (rtx rtl)
8471 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8473 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8475 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8476 regno = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
8477 #endif
8479 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8482 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8483 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8484 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
8486 static void
8487 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
8489 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8491 if (*list_head != NULL)
8493 /* Find the end of the chain. */
8494 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8497 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
8498 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
8502 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8503 zero if there is none. */
8505 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8506 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8508 rtx regs;
8510 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8511 return 0;
8513 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8515 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
8516 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8517 else
8518 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8521 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8522 a given hard register number. */
8524 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8525 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8527 if (regno <= 31)
8528 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8529 else
8530 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8533 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8534 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
8536 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8537 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8539 int nregs, size, i;
8540 unsigned reg;
8541 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8543 reg = REGNO (rtl);
8544 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8545 reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
8546 #endif
8547 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8548 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8550 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
8551 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8553 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8555 loc_result = NULL;
8556 while (nregs--)
8558 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8560 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg));
8561 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8562 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8563 ++reg;
8565 return loc_result;
8568 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
8570 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8572 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8573 loc_result = NULL;
8575 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8577 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8579 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8580 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8581 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8582 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8584 return loc_result;
8587 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
8589 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8590 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8592 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8594 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8595 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
8596 if (i >= 0)
8598 if (i <= 31)
8599 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8600 else if (i <= 0xff)
8601 op = DW_OP_const1u;
8602 else if (i <= 0xffff)
8603 op = DW_OP_const2u;
8604 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8605 || i <= 0xffffffff)
8606 op = DW_OP_const4u;
8607 else
8608 op = DW_OP_constu;
8610 else
8612 if (i >= -0x80)
8613 op = DW_OP_const1s;
8614 else if (i >= -0x8000)
8615 op = DW_OP_const2s;
8616 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8617 || i >= -0x80000000)
8618 op = DW_OP_const4s;
8619 else
8620 op = DW_OP_consts;
8623 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8626 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
8628 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8629 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
8631 unsigned int regno;
8633 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
8634 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
8635 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
8636 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
8637 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
8639 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
8641 if (elim != reg)
8643 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
8645 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
8646 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
8648 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
8649 : stack_pointer_rtx));
8650 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
8652 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8656 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
8657 if (regno <= 31)
8658 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + regno, offset, 0);
8659 else
8660 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
8663 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
8665 static inline int
8666 is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8668 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8669 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8670 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8671 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8674 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8675 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8676 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8677 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8679 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8680 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8681 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8682 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8684 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8685 autoincrement addressing modes.
8687 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
8688 location list for RTL.
8690 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
8692 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8693 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode)
8695 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8696 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8698 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8699 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8700 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8701 zeroth element of the array. */
8703 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
8705 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8707 case POST_INC:
8708 case POST_DEC:
8709 case POST_MODIFY:
8710 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
8711 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
8713 /* ... fall through ... */
8715 case SUBREG:
8716 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8717 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8718 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8719 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8720 contains the given subreg. */
8721 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8723 /* ... fall through ... */
8725 case REG:
8726 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8727 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8728 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8729 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
8730 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8731 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8732 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8733 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8734 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8735 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
8736 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8737 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8738 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
8739 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8740 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0);
8741 break;
8743 case MEM:
8744 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8745 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8746 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8747 break;
8749 case LO_SUM:
8750 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8752 /* ... fall through ... */
8754 case LABEL_REF:
8755 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8756 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8757 pool. */
8758 case CONST:
8759 case SYMBOL_REF:
8760 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8761 by a different symbol. */
8762 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8764 bool marked;
8765 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8767 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8769 rtl = tmp;
8770 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8771 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8772 else
8773 marked = true;
8776 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8777 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8778 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8779 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
8780 if (!marked)
8781 return 0;
8784 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8785 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8786 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8787 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
8788 break;
8790 case PRE_MODIFY:
8791 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8792 PLUS code below. */
8793 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8794 goto plus;
8796 case PRE_INC:
8797 case PRE_DEC:
8798 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8799 below. */
8800 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8801 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8802 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8803 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8805 /* ... fall through ... */
8807 case PLUS:
8808 plus:
8809 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8810 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
8811 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
8812 else
8814 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8815 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8816 break;
8818 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8819 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8820 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8821 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8822 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8823 else
8825 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8826 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
8827 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8828 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8831 break;
8833 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8834 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
8835 case MULT:
8836 op = DW_OP_mul;
8837 goto do_binop;
8839 case ASHIFT:
8840 op = DW_OP_shl;
8841 goto do_binop;
8843 case ASHIFTRT:
8844 op = DW_OP_shra;
8845 goto do_binop;
8847 case LSHIFTRT:
8848 op = DW_OP_shr;
8849 goto do_binop;
8851 do_binop:
8853 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8854 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
8856 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
8857 break;
8859 mem_loc_result = op0;
8860 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
8861 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8862 break;
8865 case CONST_INT:
8866 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
8867 break;
8869 default:
8870 gcc_unreachable ();
8873 return mem_loc_result;
8876 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
8877 This is typically a complex variable. */
8879 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8880 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
8882 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
8883 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
8884 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
8886 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
8887 return 0;
8889 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
8890 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
8892 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
8893 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
8895 return cc_loc_result;
8898 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
8899 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
8900 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
8901 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
8902 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
8904 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
8906 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8907 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8909 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8911 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8913 case SUBREG:
8914 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8915 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8916 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8917 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8918 contains the given subreg. */
8919 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
8921 /* ... fall through ... */
8923 case REG:
8924 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
8925 break;
8927 case MEM:
8928 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8929 break;
8931 case CONCAT:
8932 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
8933 break;
8935 case VAR_LOCATION:
8936 /* Single part. */
8937 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
8939 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0));
8940 break;
8943 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8944 /* FALLTHRU */
8946 case PARALLEL:
8948 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
8949 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
8950 enum machine_mode mode;
8951 int i;
8953 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
8954 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
8955 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
8956 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
8957 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
8959 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
8961 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
8962 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
8963 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
8964 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
8967 break;
8969 default:
8970 gcc_unreachable ();
8973 return loc_result;
8976 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
8977 up particularly with variable length arrays. WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
8978 a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
8979 top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
8980 the value of LOC. */
8982 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8983 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
8985 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
8986 int have_address = 0;
8987 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8989 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
8990 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
8991 problem... */
8993 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
8995 case ERROR_MARK:
8996 return 0;
8998 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
8999 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9000 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
9001 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9002 the names of types. */
9003 return 0;
9005 case CALL_EXPR:
9006 return 0;
9008 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9009 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9010 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9011 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9012 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
9013 return 0;
9015 case ADDR_EXPR:
9016 /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do. */
9017 if (want_address)
9018 return 0;
9020 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
9021 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
9023 case VAR_DECL:
9024 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
9026 rtx rtl;
9028 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
9029 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
9030 return 0;
9032 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
9033 look up addresses of objects in the current module. */
9034 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
9035 return 0;
9037 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9038 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9039 return 0;
9041 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
9042 return 0;
9043 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9044 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9045 return 0;
9047 ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
9048 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9049 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9051 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
9052 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9054 have_address = 1;
9055 break;
9057 /* FALLTHRU */
9059 case PARM_DECL:
9060 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
9061 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
9062 want_address);
9063 /* FALLTHRU */
9065 case RESULT_DECL:
9067 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9069 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9070 return 0;
9071 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
9073 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9074 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
9075 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
9076 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
9078 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
9079 return 0;
9080 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9082 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9083 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9084 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9086 else
9088 enum machine_mode mode;
9090 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
9091 if (want_address == 2)
9092 return loc_descriptor (rtl);
9094 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9095 if (MEM_P (rtl))
9097 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9098 have_address = 1;
9100 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9103 break;
9105 case INDIRECT_REF:
9106 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9107 have_address = 1;
9108 break;
9110 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9111 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9113 case NOP_EXPR:
9114 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9115 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9116 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9117 case SAVE_EXPR:
9118 case MODIFY_EXPR:
9119 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
9121 case COMPONENT_REF:
9122 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9123 case ARRAY_REF:
9124 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9126 tree obj, offset;
9127 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9128 enum machine_mode mode;
9129 int volatilep;
9130 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9132 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9133 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9135 if (obj == loc)
9136 return 0;
9138 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9139 if (ret == 0
9140 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9141 return 0;
9143 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9145 /* Variable offset. */
9146 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9147 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9150 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9151 if (bytepos > 0)
9152 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9153 else if (bytepos < 0)
9155 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9156 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9159 have_address = 1;
9160 break;
9163 case INTEGER_CST:
9164 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9165 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9166 else
9167 return 0;
9168 break;
9170 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9172 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
9173 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9174 enum machine_mode mode;
9176 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9177 return 0;
9178 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9179 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9180 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9181 have_address = 1;
9182 break;
9185 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9186 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9187 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9188 op = DW_OP_and;
9189 goto do_binop;
9191 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9192 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9193 op = DW_OP_xor;
9194 goto do_binop;
9196 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9197 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9198 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9199 op = DW_OP_or;
9200 goto do_binop;
9202 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9203 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9204 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9205 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9206 op = DW_OP_div;
9207 goto do_binop;
9209 case MINUS_EXPR:
9210 op = DW_OP_minus;
9211 goto do_binop;
9213 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9214 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9215 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9216 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9217 op = DW_OP_mod;
9218 goto do_binop;
9220 case MULT_EXPR:
9221 op = DW_OP_mul;
9222 goto do_binop;
9224 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9225 op = DW_OP_shl;
9226 goto do_binop;
9228 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9229 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9230 goto do_binop;
9232 case PLUS_EXPR:
9233 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9234 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9236 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9237 if (ret == 0)
9238 return 0;
9240 add_loc_descr (&ret,
9241 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9242 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9244 0));
9245 break;
9248 op = DW_OP_plus;
9249 goto do_binop;
9251 case LE_EXPR:
9252 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9253 return 0;
9255 op = DW_OP_le;
9256 goto do_binop;
9258 case GE_EXPR:
9259 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9260 return 0;
9262 op = DW_OP_ge;
9263 goto do_binop;
9265 case LT_EXPR:
9266 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9267 return 0;
9269 op = DW_OP_lt;
9270 goto do_binop;
9272 case GT_EXPR:
9273 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9274 return 0;
9276 op = DW_OP_gt;
9277 goto do_binop;
9279 case EQ_EXPR:
9280 op = DW_OP_eq;
9281 goto do_binop;
9283 case NE_EXPR:
9284 op = DW_OP_ne;
9285 goto do_binop;
9287 do_binop:
9288 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9289 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9290 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9291 return 0;
9293 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9294 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9295 break;
9297 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9298 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9299 op = DW_OP_not;
9300 goto do_unop;
9302 case ABS_EXPR:
9303 op = DW_OP_abs;
9304 goto do_unop;
9306 case NEGATE_EXPR:
9307 op = DW_OP_neg;
9308 goto do_unop;
9310 do_unop:
9311 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9312 if (ret == 0)
9313 return 0;
9315 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9316 break;
9318 case MIN_EXPR:
9319 case MAX_EXPR:
9321 const enum tree_code code =
9322 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9324 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9325 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9326 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9327 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9330 /* ... fall through ... */
9332 case COND_EXPR:
9334 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9335 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9336 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9337 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9338 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9340 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9341 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9342 return 0;
9344 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9345 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9347 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9348 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9349 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9351 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9352 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9353 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9355 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
9356 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9357 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9358 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9359 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9361 break;
9363 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9364 case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
9365 case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
9366 case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
9367 return 0;
9369 default:
9370 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
9371 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
9372 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9373 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9374 return 0;
9376 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9377 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9378 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
9379 gcc_unreachable ();
9380 #else
9381 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9382 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
9383 return NULL;
9384 #endif
9387 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
9388 if (want_address && !have_address)
9389 return 0;
9391 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
9392 if (!want_address && have_address && ret)
9394 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9396 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9397 return 0;
9398 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9399 op = DW_OP_deref;
9400 else
9401 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9403 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9406 return ret;
9409 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
9410 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9412 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9415 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9416 which is not less than the value itself. */
9418 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9419 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9421 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9424 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9425 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9426 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9427 ERROR_MARK node. */
9429 static inline tree
9430 field_type (tree decl)
9432 tree type;
9434 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9435 return integer_type_node;
9437 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9438 if (type == NULL_TREE)
9439 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9441 return type;
9444 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9445 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9446 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
9448 static inline unsigned
9449 simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
9451 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9454 static inline unsigned
9455 simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
9457 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9460 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9461 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9462 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9463 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9464 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
9465 just yet). */
9467 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9468 field_byte_offset (tree decl)
9470 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9471 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9472 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
9473 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9474 tree type;
9475 tree field_size_tree;
9476 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9477 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9478 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9480 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9481 return 0;
9483 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9485 type = field_type (decl);
9486 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
9488 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9489 a flexible array member. */
9490 if (! field_size_tree)
9491 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
9493 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9494 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
9495 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
9496 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9497 return 0;
9499 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9501 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
9502 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
9503 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
9504 else
9505 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
9507 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9508 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
9509 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
9511 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
9512 bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
9513 hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
9514 the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
9515 bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
9516 tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
9517 type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
9518 long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
9520 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
9522 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
9523 cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
9524 structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
9525 for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
9526 bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
9527 boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
9528 of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
9529 there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
9530 (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
9531 bits of the bit-field itself.
9533 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
9534 object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
9535 allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
9536 to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
9537 boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
9538 bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
9539 bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
9540 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
9541 object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
9543 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
9544 given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
9545 that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
9546 we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
9547 DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
9548 and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
9550 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
9551 "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
9552 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
9554 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
9555 lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
9556 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9558 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
9559 object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
9560 object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
9561 object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
9563 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
9565 /* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
9566 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9568 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
9569 object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
9570 object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
9571 object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
9574 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9577 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
9578 associated with them. */
9580 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
9582 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
9583 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
9584 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
9586 static inline void
9587 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9588 dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
9590 if (descr != 0)
9591 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
9594 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
9595 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
9596 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
9597 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
9598 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
9599 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
9600 function above).
9602 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9603 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
9604 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9605 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
9606 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
9607 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
9608 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
9609 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
9610 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
9611 function below.) */
9613 static void
9614 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9616 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9617 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9619 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
9621 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
9622 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
9624 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9625 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9626 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9627 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
9629 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9631 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
9633 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9635 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
9636 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9637 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9639 /* Extract the vtable address. */
9640 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9641 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9643 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
9644 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9645 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
9647 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9648 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9649 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9650 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9652 /* Extract the offset. */
9653 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9654 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9656 /* Add it to the object address. */
9657 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9658 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9660 else
9661 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9663 else
9664 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9666 if (! loc_descr)
9668 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9670 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9671 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9672 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
9674 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9675 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9676 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
9677 stack. */
9678 op = DW_OP_constu;
9679 #else
9680 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9681 #endif
9683 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9686 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9689 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
9691 static void
9692 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
9694 while (size != 0)
9696 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
9697 val >>= 8;
9698 --size;
9702 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
9704 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9705 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
9707 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
9709 src += size;
9710 while (size != 0)
9712 val <<= 8;
9713 val |= *--src & 0xff;
9714 --size;
9716 return val;
9719 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
9721 static void
9722 insert_float (rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
9724 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9725 long val[4];
9726 int i;
9728 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9729 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
9731 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
9732 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
9734 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
9735 array += 4;
9739 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9740 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
9741 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9742 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
9743 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
9745 static void
9746 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9748 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9750 case CONST_INT:
9752 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9754 if (val < 0)
9755 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
9756 else
9757 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
9759 break;
9761 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9762 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9763 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9764 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9765 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
9767 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9769 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
9771 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
9772 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
9774 insert_float (rtl, array);
9775 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
9777 else
9779 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
9780 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
9782 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9783 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9786 break;
9788 case CONST_VECTOR:
9790 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9791 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
9792 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
9793 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
9794 unsigned int i;
9795 unsigned char *p;
9797 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
9799 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
9800 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9802 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9803 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
9805 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
9807 case CONST_INT:
9808 lo = INTVAL (elt);
9809 hi = -(lo < 0);
9810 break;
9812 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9813 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
9814 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
9815 break;
9817 default:
9818 gcc_unreachable ();
9821 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9822 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
9823 else
9825 unsigned char *p0 = p;
9826 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
9828 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
9829 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9831 p0 = p1;
9832 p1 = p;
9834 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
9835 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
9838 break;
9840 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
9841 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9843 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9844 insert_float (elt, p);
9846 break;
9848 default:
9849 gcc_unreachable ();
9852 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
9854 break;
9856 case CONST_STRING:
9857 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
9858 break;
9860 case SYMBOL_REF:
9861 case LABEL_REF:
9862 case CONST:
9863 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
9864 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
9865 break;
9867 case PLUS:
9868 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
9869 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
9870 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
9871 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
9872 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
9873 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
9874 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
9875 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
9876 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
9877 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
9878 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
9879 break;
9881 default:
9882 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
9883 gcc_unreachable ();
9888 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
9889 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
9891 static rtx
9892 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
9894 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
9896 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
9897 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
9898 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
9900 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
9901 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
9902 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
9904 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
9905 && domain
9906 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
9907 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
9908 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
9909 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
9910 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
9911 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
9912 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
9914 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
9915 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. Expanding anything else
9916 tends to produce unresolved symbols; see debug/5770 and c++/6381. */
9917 /* Aggregate, vector, and complex types may contain constructors that may
9918 result in code being generated when expand_expr is called, so we can't
9919 handle them here. Integer and float are useful and safe types to handle
9920 here. */
9921 else if ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) || SCALAR_FLOAT_TYPE_P (type))
9922 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type) == null_pointer_node)
9924 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
9926 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
9927 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
9930 return rtl;
9933 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
9935 static rtx
9936 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
9938 rtx rtl;
9940 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
9941 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
9942 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
9944 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
9945 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
9946 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
9947 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
9948 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
9949 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
9950 referenced within the function.
9952 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
9953 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
9954 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
9955 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
9957 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
9958 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
9959 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
9960 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
9961 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
9962 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
9964 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
9965 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
9966 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
9967 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
9968 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
9969 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
9970 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
9971 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
9972 output at debug-time.
9974 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
9975 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
9976 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
9977 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
9978 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
9979 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
9980 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
9981 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
9982 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
9983 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
9984 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
9985 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
9986 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
9988 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
9989 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
9990 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
9991 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
9992 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
9993 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
9994 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
9995 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
9996 I'd like to fix it.
9998 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
9999 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10000 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10001 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10002 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
10003 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10004 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10005 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10006 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
10007 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10008 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
10010 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
10011 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
10013 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10014 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10015 fixed registers. */
10016 if (! reload_completed)
10018 if (rtl
10019 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
10020 || (MEM_P (rtl)
10021 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10022 || (REG_P (rtl)
10023 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10024 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
10026 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10027 return rtl;
10029 rtl = NULL_RTX;
10031 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
10033 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
10035 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10036 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
10037 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
10038 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
10040 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10041 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10042 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
10043 if (dmode == pmode)
10044 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10045 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
10046 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10047 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10049 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10050 if (REG_P (inc))
10051 rtl = inc;
10052 else if (MEM_P (inc))
10054 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10055 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
10056 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10057 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
10058 else
10059 rtl = inc;
10064 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10065 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10066 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
10067 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10068 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
10069 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10070 thing to do. */
10071 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
10072 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
10073 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10074 /* Not passed in memory. */
10075 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10076 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
10077 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10078 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10079 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10080 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10081 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10082 #endif
10084 /* Big endian correction check. */
10085 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10086 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
10087 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
10088 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10090 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10091 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10093 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10094 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10097 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10098 && rtl
10099 && MEM_P (rtl)
10100 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10101 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10103 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10104 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10106 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10107 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10108 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10109 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
10110 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10111 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
10112 if (rsize > dsize)
10113 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10114 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10117 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10118 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10119 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
10120 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10121 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10123 if (rtl)
10124 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10126 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10127 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10128 code, and thus is not emitted. */
10129 if (rtl)
10130 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10132 return rtl;
10135 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10136 address ranges where a given location is valid.
10137 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10138 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10139 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10140 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
10142 static const char *
10143 secname_for_decl (tree decl)
10145 const char *secname;
10147 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10149 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10150 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10152 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10154 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10155 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10157 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
10158 secname = cfun->cold_section_label;
10159 else
10160 secname = text_section_label;
10162 return secname;
10165 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10166 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
10167 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10168 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10169 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10170 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
10171 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
10172 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10173 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10174 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
10176 static void
10177 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10178 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10180 rtx rtl;
10181 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10182 var_loc_list *loc_list;
10183 struct var_loc_node *node;
10184 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10185 return;
10187 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10188 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10190 /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable. */
10191 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10193 /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10194 differ. */
10195 if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10197 const char *endname, *secname;
10198 dw_loc_list_ref list;
10199 rtx varloc;
10201 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10202 actually construct the list of locations.
10203 The first location information is what is passed to the
10204 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10205 locations just get added on to that list.
10206 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10207 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10208 the range [current location start, next location start].
10209 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10210 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
10212 node = loc_list->first;
10213 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10214 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
10216 list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc),
10217 node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10218 node = node->next;
10220 for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10221 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10223 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10224 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
10225 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10226 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10227 node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10230 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10231 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
10232 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10234 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10236 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10237 if (!current_function_decl)
10238 endname = text_end_label;
10239 else
10241 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10242 current_function_funcdef_no);
10243 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10245 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10246 node->label, endname, secname);
10249 /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done. */
10250 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
10251 return;
10254 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10255 the location. */
10257 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
10258 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
10260 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
10261 return;
10264 /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10265 didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10266 location list, try generating a location from that. */
10267 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
10269 node = loc_list->first;
10270 descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note));
10271 if (descr)
10273 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10274 return;
10278 /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
10279 description from the tree. */
10280 descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
10281 if (descr)
10283 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10284 return;
10288 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10289 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10290 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
10292 static void
10293 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
10295 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10296 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10297 rtx rtl;
10299 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
10300 /* OK */;
10301 else
10302 return;
10304 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
10305 if (rtl)
10306 add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
10309 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
10310 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
10311 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
10312 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
10313 expressions. */
10315 static dw_loc_list_ref
10316 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10318 dw_fde_ref fde;
10319 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
10320 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
10321 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
10322 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
10324 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
10326 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
10327 list_tail = &list;
10328 list = NULL;
10330 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
10331 next_cfa.offset = 0;
10332 next_cfa.indirect = 0;
10333 next_cfa.base_offset = 0;
10335 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
10337 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
10338 advance opcodes. */
10339 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10340 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10342 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10343 last_label = start_label;
10345 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10346 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
10348 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
10349 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
10350 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
10351 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10353 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10354 start_label, last_label, section,
10355 list == NULL);
10357 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10358 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10359 start_label = last_label;
10361 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
10362 break;
10364 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
10365 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
10366 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
10367 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
10368 /* We don't handle these two in this function. It would be possible
10369 if it were to be required. */
10370 gcc_unreachable ();
10372 default:
10373 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10374 break;
10377 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10379 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10380 start_label, last_label, section,
10381 list == NULL);
10382 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10383 start_label = last_label;
10385 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
10386 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
10387 list == NULL);
10389 return list;
10392 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
10393 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
10394 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
10395 before the latter is negated. */
10397 static void
10398 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10400 rtx reg, elim;
10402 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10403 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10404 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10405 #else
10406 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10407 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10408 #endif
10410 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10411 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10413 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
10414 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10416 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10417 : stack_pointer_rtx));
10419 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
10422 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
10423 the value of the attribute. */
10425 static void
10426 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
10428 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
10430 if (demangle_name_func)
10431 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
10433 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
10437 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
10439 static void
10440 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
10442 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
10443 if (wd != NULL)
10444 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10447 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
10448 a representation for that bound. */
10450 static void
10451 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
10453 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
10455 case ERROR_MARK:
10456 return;
10458 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
10459 case INTEGER_CST:
10460 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
10461 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
10462 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
10463 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
10464 /* Use the default. */
10466 else
10467 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
10468 break;
10470 case CONVERT_EXPR:
10471 case NOP_EXPR:
10472 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
10473 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10474 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
10475 break;
10477 case SAVE_EXPR:
10478 break;
10480 case VAR_DECL:
10481 case PARM_DECL:
10482 case RESULT_DECL:
10484 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
10486 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
10487 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
10488 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
10489 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
10490 later parameter. */
10491 if (decl_die != NULL)
10492 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10493 break;
10496 default:
10498 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
10499 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
10501 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
10502 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10504 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
10505 if (loc == NULL)
10506 break;
10508 if (current_function_decl == 0)
10509 ctx = comp_unit_die;
10510 else
10511 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
10513 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
10514 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10515 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
10516 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
10518 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10519 break;
10524 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
10525 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
10527 static void
10528 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
10530 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10531 unsigned dimension_number;
10532 #endif
10533 tree lower, upper;
10534 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10536 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
10537 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
10538 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
10539 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
10540 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
10541 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
10542 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
10543 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
10545 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10546 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10547 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
10548 gen_array_type_die. */
10549 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10550 for (dimension_number = 0;
10551 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
10552 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
10553 #endif
10555 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10557 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
10558 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
10559 here. */
10560 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
10561 if (domain)
10563 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
10564 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
10565 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
10567 /* Define the index type. */
10568 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
10570 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
10571 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
10572 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
10573 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
10574 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
10575 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10576 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
10578 else
10579 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
10580 type_die);
10583 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
10584 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
10585 dimension arr(N:*)
10586 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
10587 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
10588 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
10590 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
10591 if (upper)
10592 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
10595 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
10596 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
10597 bounds. */
10601 static void
10602 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
10604 unsigned size;
10606 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
10608 case ERROR_MARK:
10609 size = 0;
10610 break;
10611 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10612 case RECORD_TYPE:
10613 case UNION_TYPE:
10614 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10615 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
10616 break;
10617 case FIELD_DECL:
10618 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
10619 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
10620 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
10621 even for bit-fields. */
10622 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10623 break;
10624 default:
10625 gcc_unreachable ();
10628 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
10629 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
10630 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
10631 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
10632 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
10635 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
10636 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
10637 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
10638 bit-field itself.
10640 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10641 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
10642 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10643 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
10644 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
10645 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
10647 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
10648 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
10649 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
10651 static inline void
10652 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10654 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
10655 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
10656 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
10657 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
10658 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
10659 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
10661 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10662 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
10664 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
10665 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
10666 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
10667 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
10668 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10669 return;
10671 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
10673 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
10674 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
10675 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
10676 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
10677 below must take account of these differences. */
10678 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10679 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
10681 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10683 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
10684 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10687 bit_offset
10688 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10689 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
10690 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
10692 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
10695 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
10696 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
10698 static inline void
10699 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10701 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10702 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
10703 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
10705 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10706 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
10709 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
10710 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
10712 static inline void
10713 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
10715 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
10716 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
10717 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
10720 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
10721 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
10722 equate table. */
10724 static inline void
10725 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
10727 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
10729 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10731 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
10732 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
10733 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
10735 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
10736 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
10737 tree fn = origin;
10739 if (TYPE_P (fn))
10740 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
10742 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
10743 if (fn)
10744 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
10747 if (DECL_P (origin))
10748 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
10749 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
10750 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
10752 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
10753 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
10754 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
10755 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
10756 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
10757 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
10758 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
10759 here. */
10761 if (origin_die)
10762 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
10765 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
10767 static inline void
10768 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
10770 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
10772 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10774 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
10775 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
10776 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
10777 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
10778 0));
10780 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
10781 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10782 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10783 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
10787 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
10789 static void
10790 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10792 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
10793 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
10795 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10796 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
10799 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
10800 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
10802 static void
10803 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10805 tree decl_name;
10807 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
10808 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
10810 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
10811 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10812 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
10814 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
10815 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
10816 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
10817 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
10818 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
10819 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
10820 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
10823 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10824 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
10825 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
10826 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
10828 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
10829 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
10830 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
10832 #endif
10835 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
10837 static void
10838 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
10840 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
10843 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
10845 static inline void
10846 pop_decl_scope (void)
10848 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
10851 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
10852 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
10853 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
10854 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
10855 the current active scope. */
10857 static dw_die_ref
10858 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
10860 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
10861 tree containing_scope;
10862 int i;
10864 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
10865 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
10867 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
10869 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
10870 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
10872 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
10873 /* OK */;
10874 else
10875 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
10878 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
10879 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
10880 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
10881 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
10882 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
10884 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
10885 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10886 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
10888 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
10889 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
10890 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
10891 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10892 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
10893 break;
10895 if (i < 0)
10897 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
10898 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
10900 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
10901 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10903 else
10904 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
10906 else
10907 scope_die = context_die;
10909 return scope_die;
10912 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
10914 static inline int
10915 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10917 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
10918 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
10919 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
10920 return 1;
10922 return 0;
10925 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
10926 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
10928 static inline int
10929 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10931 return (context_die
10932 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
10933 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
10934 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
10937 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
10938 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
10939 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
10941 static void
10942 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
10943 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
10945 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
10946 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
10948 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
10949 floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
10950 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
10951 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
10952 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
10953 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
10954 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
10956 if (code == ERROR_MARK
10957 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
10958 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
10959 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
10960 || code == VOID_TYPE)
10961 return;
10963 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
10964 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
10965 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
10966 context_die);
10968 if (type_die != NULL)
10969 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
10972 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
10973 function call type. */
10974 static void
10975 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree type)
10977 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
10979 value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (type);
10981 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
10982 is not DW_CC_normal. */
10983 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
10984 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
10987 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
10988 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
10989 was declared without a tag. */
10991 static const char *
10992 type_tag (tree type)
10994 const char *name = 0;
10996 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
10998 tree t = 0;
11000 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
11001 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11002 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
11004 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11005 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11006 involved. */
11007 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11008 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11009 t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
11011 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
11012 if (t != 0)
11013 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
11016 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
11019 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11020 for bit field types. */
11022 static inline tree
11023 member_declared_type (tree member)
11025 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
11026 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
11029 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11030 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11032 #if 0
11033 static const char *
11034 decl_start_label (tree decl)
11036 rtx x;
11037 const char *fnname;
11039 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
11040 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
11042 x = XEXP (x, 0);
11043 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
11045 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
11046 return fnname;
11048 #endif
11050 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11051 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
11052 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
11054 static void
11055 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11057 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11058 dw_die_ref array_die;
11059 tree element_type;
11061 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11062 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
11063 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
11064 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11065 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11066 #endif
11068 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
11069 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
11070 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
11072 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11074 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11075 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
11076 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
11077 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
11080 #if 0
11081 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
11082 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
11083 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
11084 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11085 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
11086 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11087 for multidimensional arrays. */
11088 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
11089 #endif
11091 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11092 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11093 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
11094 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
11095 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11096 else
11097 #endif
11098 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
11100 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
11101 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11103 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11104 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11105 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
11106 add_subscript_info. */
11107 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11108 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11109 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
11111 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
11112 #endif
11114 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11117 #if 0
11118 static void
11119 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11121 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11122 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
11124 if (origin != NULL)
11125 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
11126 else
11128 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11129 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11130 0, 0, context_die);
11133 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11134 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
11135 else
11136 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
11138 #endif
11140 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
11141 emit full debugging info for them. */
11143 static void
11144 retry_incomplete_types (void)
11146 int i;
11148 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11149 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
11152 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
11154 static void
11155 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11157 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
11159 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11160 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11161 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11164 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
11166 static void
11167 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11169 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
11171 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11172 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11173 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11176 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
11178 static void
11179 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11181 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
11183 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11184 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11185 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11188 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
11189 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11190 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11191 DIE. */
11193 static dw_die_ref
11194 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11196 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11198 if (type_die == NULL)
11200 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
11201 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11202 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11203 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11205 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
11206 return type_die;
11207 else
11208 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11210 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
11211 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
11212 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
11213 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11215 tree link;
11217 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11218 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11219 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11220 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11222 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11223 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
11224 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11225 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
11227 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
11228 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11230 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
11231 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
11233 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
11234 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
11236 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
11237 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
11238 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
11239 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
11240 values as if they were signed. That means that
11241 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
11242 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
11243 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
11244 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
11247 else
11248 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11250 return type_die;
11253 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
11254 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
11255 type.
11257 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
11258 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
11259 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
11260 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
11261 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
11262 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
11263 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
11264 argument type of some subprogram type. */
11266 static dw_die_ref
11267 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
11269 dw_die_ref parm_die
11270 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
11271 tree origin;
11273 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
11275 case tcc_declaration:
11276 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
11277 if (origin != NULL)
11278 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
11279 else
11281 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
11282 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
11283 TREE_READONLY (node),
11284 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
11285 context_die);
11286 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
11287 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11290 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
11291 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
11292 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
11294 break;
11296 case tcc_type:
11297 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
11298 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
11299 break;
11301 default:
11302 gcc_unreachable ();
11305 return parm_die;
11308 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
11309 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
11311 static void
11312 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11314 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
11317 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
11318 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
11319 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
11320 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
11322 static void
11323 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11325 tree link;
11326 tree formal_type = NULL;
11327 tree first_parm_type;
11328 tree arg;
11330 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11332 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
11333 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
11335 else
11336 arg = NULL_TREE;
11338 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11340 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
11341 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
11342 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
11344 dw_die_ref parm_die;
11346 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
11347 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
11348 break;
11350 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
11351 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
11352 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
11353 && link == first_parm_type)
11354 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
11355 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11357 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
11358 if (arg)
11359 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
11362 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
11363 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
11364 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
11365 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
11367 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
11368 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
11369 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11370 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
11371 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11372 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
11375 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
11376 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
11377 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
11378 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
11379 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
11381 static void
11382 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
11384 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11386 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
11387 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
11388 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
11389 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
11391 dw_die_ref type_die;
11392 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
11394 push_decl_scope (type);
11395 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11396 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11397 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
11398 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
11400 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
11401 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
11402 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
11403 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
11404 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
11406 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
11407 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
11410 else
11411 gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
11413 pop_decl_scope ();
11417 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
11418 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
11420 static void
11421 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
11423 dw_die_ref old_die;
11424 tree save_fn;
11425 tree context;
11426 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
11428 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
11429 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
11431 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11432 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11433 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
11434 return;
11436 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
11437 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
11438 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11440 context = decl_class_context (decl);
11441 if (context)
11442 gen_type_die_for_member
11443 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
11446 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
11447 save_fn = current_function_decl;
11448 current_function_decl = decl;
11450 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
11451 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11452 if (! was_abstract)
11453 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
11455 current_function_decl = save_fn;
11458 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
11459 block-local). */
11461 static void
11462 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11464 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11465 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11466 dw_die_ref subr_die;
11467 tree fn_arg_types;
11468 tree outer_scope;
11469 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11470 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
11471 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11473 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
11474 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
11475 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
11476 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
11477 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
11479 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
11480 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
11482 origin = NULL;
11483 gcc_assert (!old_die);
11486 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
11487 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
11488 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
11489 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11490 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
11491 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11492 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
11494 if (origin != NULL)
11496 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
11498 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
11499 inline function. */
11500 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
11501 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
11503 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11504 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
11506 else if (old_die)
11508 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11509 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11511 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
11512 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
11513 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
11514 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
11515 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11517 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
11518 something we have already output. */
11519 return;
11522 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
11523 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
11524 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
11525 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
11526 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
11527 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
11528 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
11529 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
11530 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11531 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
11532 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11533 == (unsigned) s.line))))
11535 subr_die = old_die;
11537 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
11538 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
11539 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
11540 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
11541 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
11542 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11543 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
11545 else
11547 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11548 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
11549 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11550 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11551 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11552 != (unsigned) s.line)
11553 add_AT_unsigned
11554 (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11557 else
11559 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11561 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11562 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11564 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
11565 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11567 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11568 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11569 0, 0, context_die);
11572 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11573 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11574 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11576 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11577 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11578 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11579 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11582 if (declaration)
11584 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11586 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11588 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
11589 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
11590 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
11591 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
11593 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
11594 later reused to represent definition. */
11595 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11598 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11600 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
11602 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11603 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
11604 else
11605 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
11607 else
11609 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11610 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
11611 else
11612 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
11615 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11617 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
11619 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
11621 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11622 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11624 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
11626 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
11627 current_function_funcdef_no);
11628 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
11629 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
11630 current_function_funcdef_no);
11631 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
11633 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11634 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11636 else
11637 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
11638 hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
11639 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
11641 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
11642 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
11643 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
11644 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
11646 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11647 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11648 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11652 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11653 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
11654 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
11655 #endif
11657 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
11659 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
11660 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
11661 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
11662 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
11663 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
11664 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
11665 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
11666 function. */
11667 /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
11668 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. At present there are no dwarf
11669 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
11670 convert the CFA data into a location list. */
11672 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
11673 if (list->dw_loc_next)
11674 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
11675 else
11676 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
11679 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
11680 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
11681 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
11682 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
11683 by this displacement. */
11684 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
11686 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
11687 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
11688 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
11691 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
11692 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
11693 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
11694 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
11695 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
11696 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
11697 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
11698 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
11699 an ellipsis at the end. */
11701 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
11702 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
11703 its formal parameters. */
11704 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11706 else if (declaration)
11707 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
11708 else
11710 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
11711 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
11712 tree parm;
11714 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
11715 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
11716 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
11717 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11719 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
11720 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
11721 "__builtin_va_alist"))
11722 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
11723 else
11724 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
11727 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
11728 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
11729 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
11730 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
11731 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
11732 parameters at all. */
11733 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11734 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
11736 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
11737 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
11738 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11740 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
11741 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11744 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
11745 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
11746 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
11748 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
11749 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
11750 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
11751 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
11752 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
11753 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
11754 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
11756 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
11757 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
11758 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
11759 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
11760 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
11761 constructor function. */
11762 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
11764 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
11765 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
11766 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
11768 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
11769 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
11771 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11772 if (current_function_has_inlines)
11774 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11775 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
11777 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11778 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
11781 #endif
11783 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
11784 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11788 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
11790 static void
11791 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11793 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11794 dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
11796 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11797 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
11798 /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
11799 emitted, we cannot take its address; there
11800 might end up being no definition anywhere in
11801 the program. For example, consider the C++
11802 test case:
11804 template <class T>
11805 struct S { static const int i = 7; };
11807 template <class T>
11808 const int S<T>::i;
11810 int f() { return S<int>::i; }
11812 Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
11813 definition is required, so the compiler will
11814 not emit a definition. */
11815 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
11816 && DECL_COMDAT (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11817 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11819 if (origin != NULL)
11820 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
11822 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
11823 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
11825 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
11826 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
11827 sharing them.
11829 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
11831 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
11832 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
11833 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
11834 declaration. */
11835 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
11836 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
11838 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
11839 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
11840 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
11842 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11843 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11845 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11846 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11848 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11849 != (unsigned) s.line)
11851 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11854 else
11856 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
11857 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
11858 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
11860 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11861 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11863 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11864 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11866 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11867 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11868 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11869 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11872 if (declaration)
11873 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11875 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
11876 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
11878 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11880 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
11881 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
11883 else
11884 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
11887 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
11889 static void
11890 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11892 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11893 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
11894 rtx insn;
11895 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11897 if (origin != NULL)
11898 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
11899 else
11900 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
11902 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11903 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
11904 else
11906 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
11908 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
11909 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
11910 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
11911 if (insn
11912 && (LABEL_P (insn)
11913 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
11914 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
11916 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
11917 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
11918 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
11919 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
11920 it if it ever does happen. */
11921 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
11923 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
11924 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
11929 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
11930 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
11931 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
11933 static inline void
11934 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
11936 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
11937 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11939 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_file, file_index);
11940 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
11943 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
11944 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
11946 static inline void
11947 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
11949 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11951 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
11953 tree chain;
11955 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
11957 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
11960 add_ranges (chain);
11961 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
11963 while (chain);
11964 add_ranges (NULL);
11966 else
11968 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
11969 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
11970 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
11971 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
11972 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
11973 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
11977 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
11979 static void
11980 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
11982 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
11984 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
11985 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
11987 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
11990 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
11992 static void
11993 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
11995 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
11997 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
11998 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
11999 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
12000 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
12001 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12003 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12005 dw_die_ref subr_die
12006 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
12008 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12009 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12010 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12012 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
12013 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
12015 else
12016 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
12017 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
12018 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
12019 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
12020 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
12021 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
12022 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
12023 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
12024 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
12025 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
12026 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
12027 intended :-) */
12028 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12031 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
12033 static void
12034 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12036 dw_die_ref decl_die;
12038 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
12039 return;
12041 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
12042 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
12043 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
12044 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
12045 context_die);
12047 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
12049 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12050 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12051 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12054 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
12055 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12057 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12058 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12060 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12061 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12062 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12063 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12065 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
12066 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
12069 #if 0
12070 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12071 Use modified_type_die instead.
12072 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12073 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12075 static void
12076 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12078 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12079 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12081 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12082 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12083 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12086 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12087 Use modified_type_die instead.
12088 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12089 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12091 static void
12092 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12094 dw_die_ref ref_die
12095 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12097 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
12098 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12099 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12101 #endif
12103 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
12105 static void
12106 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12108 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12109 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
12110 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12112 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12113 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12114 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
12115 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12118 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
12120 static dw_die_ref
12121 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
12123 dw_die_ref die;
12124 char producer[250];
12125 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
12126 int language;
12128 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
12130 if (filename)
12132 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
12133 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
12134 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR && filename[0] != '<')
12135 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
12138 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
12140 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12141 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
12142 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
12143 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
12144 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
12145 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
12146 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
12147 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12148 strcat (producer, " -g");
12149 #endif
12151 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
12153 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
12154 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
12155 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
12156 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
12157 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
12158 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
12159 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F95") == 0)
12160 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
12161 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
12162 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
12163 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
12164 language = DW_LANG_Java;
12165 else
12166 language = DW_LANG_C89;
12168 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
12169 return die;
12172 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
12174 static void
12175 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
12177 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
12179 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
12180 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
12182 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
12183 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
12185 if (access == access_public_node)
12186 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
12187 else if (access == access_protected_node)
12188 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12191 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
12193 static void
12194 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12196 tree member;
12197 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
12198 dw_die_ref child;
12200 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
12201 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
12202 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
12203 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
12204 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
12205 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
12206 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
12207 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
12208 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
12209 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
12210 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
12212 /* First output info about the base classes. */
12213 if (binfo)
12215 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
12216 int i;
12217 tree base;
12219 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
12220 gen_inheritance_die (base,
12221 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
12222 : access_public_node), context_die);
12225 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
12226 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12228 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
12229 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
12230 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
12231 do put them in the right order. */
12233 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12234 if (child)
12235 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12236 else
12237 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12240 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
12241 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12243 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
12244 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
12245 continue;
12247 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12248 if (child)
12249 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12250 else
12251 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12255 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
12256 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
12257 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
12259 static void
12260 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12262 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12263 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
12264 int nested = 0;
12265 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
12266 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12267 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
12268 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
12270 if (type_die && ! complete)
12271 return;
12273 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
12274 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12275 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
12276 nested = 1;
12278 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12280 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
12281 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
12283 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
12285 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
12286 ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
12287 scope_die, type);
12288 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12289 if (old_die)
12290 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
12291 else
12292 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12294 else
12295 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12297 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
12298 then give a list of members. */
12299 if (complete && !ns_decl)
12301 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
12302 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
12303 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12304 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12305 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12306 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12308 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12309 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
12310 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12311 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
12313 push_decl_scope (type);
12314 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
12315 pop_decl_scope ();
12317 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
12318 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
12320 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
12322 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
12323 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12324 lookup_type_die (vtype));
12327 else
12329 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12331 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
12332 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12333 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
12334 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
12338 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
12340 static void
12341 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12343 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12344 dw_die_ref subr_die
12345 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
12346 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12348 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
12349 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
12350 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12351 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
12354 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
12356 static void
12357 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12359 dw_die_ref type_die;
12360 tree origin;
12362 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12363 return;
12365 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
12366 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
12367 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12368 if (origin != NULL)
12369 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
12370 else
12372 tree type;
12374 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
12375 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
12377 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
12379 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
12380 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
12382 else
12383 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12385 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12386 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12389 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12390 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
12393 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
12395 static void
12396 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12398 int need_pop;
12400 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12401 return;
12403 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12404 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12406 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12407 return;
12409 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
12410 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
12412 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12413 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
12414 return;
12417 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
12418 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
12419 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
12420 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
12421 cloned type itself). */
12422 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12423 type = type_main_variant (type);
12425 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12426 return;
12428 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12430 case ERROR_MARK:
12431 break;
12433 case POINTER_TYPE:
12434 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12435 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
12436 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
12437 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
12438 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
12439 statement. */
12440 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12442 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
12443 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
12444 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12445 break;
12447 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12448 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
12449 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
12450 gen_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die);
12452 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
12453 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12455 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
12456 itself. */
12457 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
12458 break;
12460 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12461 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12462 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12463 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12464 break;
12466 case METHOD_TYPE:
12467 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12468 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12469 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12470 break;
12472 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12473 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12474 break;
12476 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12477 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12478 break;
12480 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12481 case RECORD_TYPE:
12482 case UNION_TYPE:
12483 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12484 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
12485 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
12486 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
12487 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
12488 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
12489 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
12490 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
12491 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12492 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12494 gen_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die);
12496 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12497 return;
12499 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
12500 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12501 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12502 need_pop = 1;
12504 else
12506 declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
12507 need_pop = 0;
12510 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
12511 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12512 else
12513 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12515 if (need_pop)
12516 pop_decl_scope ();
12518 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
12519 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
12520 when appropriate. */
12521 return;
12523 case VOID_TYPE:
12524 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12525 case REAL_TYPE:
12526 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12527 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12528 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
12529 break;
12531 case LANG_TYPE:
12532 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
12533 break;
12535 default:
12536 gcc_unreachable ();
12539 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12542 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
12544 static void
12545 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12547 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12548 return;
12550 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
12551 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
12552 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
12553 type now. */
12554 gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
12556 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
12557 an instance of an unresolved type. */
12559 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12561 case ERROR_MARK:
12562 break;
12564 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12565 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12566 break;
12568 case RECORD_TYPE:
12569 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
12570 break;
12572 case UNION_TYPE:
12573 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12574 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12575 break;
12577 default:
12578 gcc_unreachable ();
12582 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
12583 things which are local to the given block. */
12585 static void
12586 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12588 int must_output_die = 0;
12589 tree origin;
12590 tree decl;
12591 enum tree_code origin_code;
12593 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
12594 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12595 return;
12597 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
12598 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
12599 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
12600 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
12602 tree sub;
12604 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
12605 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
12607 return;
12610 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
12611 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
12612 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
12613 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
12614 the current block. */
12615 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12616 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
12618 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
12619 block. */
12620 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12621 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
12622 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
12623 must_output_die = 1;
12624 else
12626 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
12627 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
12628 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
12629 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
12630 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
12631 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
12632 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
12633 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
12635 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
12636 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
12637 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12638 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
12639 as being a "significant" one. */
12640 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
12641 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
12642 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
12643 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
12644 else
12645 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
12646 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
12647 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
12648 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12649 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12650 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12652 must_output_die = 1;
12653 break;
12658 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
12659 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
12660 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
12661 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
12662 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
12663 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
12664 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
12665 if (must_output_die)
12667 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12668 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12669 else
12670 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12672 else
12673 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
12676 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
12677 all of its sub-blocks. */
12679 static void
12680 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12682 tree decl;
12683 tree subblocks;
12685 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
12686 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12687 return;
12689 if (TREE_USED (stmt))
12691 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
12692 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
12693 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
12694 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
12695 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12697 dw_die_ref die;
12699 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12700 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12701 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12702 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12703 else
12704 die = NULL;
12706 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
12707 add_child_die (context_die, die);
12708 /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
12709 these might be optimized out. We are called for these later
12710 in cgraph_varpool_analyze_pending_decls. */
12711 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl))
12713 else
12714 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12718 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
12719 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12720 return;
12722 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
12723 therein) of this block. */
12724 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
12725 subblocks != NULL;
12726 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
12727 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
12730 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
12732 static inline int
12733 is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
12735 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12736 return 1;
12738 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
12739 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
12740 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
12741 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
12742 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
12743 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
12744 return 1;
12746 return 0;
12749 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
12751 static dw_die_ref
12752 force_decl_die (tree decl)
12754 dw_die_ref decl_die;
12755 unsigned saved_external_flag;
12756 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
12757 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12758 if (!decl_die)
12760 dw_die_ref context_die;
12761 tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
12762 if (decl_context)
12764 /* Find die that represents this context. */
12765 if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
12766 context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
12767 else
12768 context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
12770 else
12771 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12773 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12774 if (decl_die)
12775 return decl_die;
12777 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
12779 case FUNCTION_DECL:
12780 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
12781 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
12782 declaration die. */
12783 save_fn = current_function_decl;
12784 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
12785 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
12786 current_function_decl = save_fn;
12787 break;
12789 case VAR_DECL:
12790 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
12791 gen_decl_die() call. */
12792 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
12793 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
12794 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12795 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
12796 break;
12798 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
12799 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
12800 break;
12802 default:
12803 gcc_unreachable ();
12806 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
12807 if (!decl_die)
12808 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12809 gcc_assert (decl_die);
12812 return decl_die;
12815 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE. A DIE is always returned. */
12817 static dw_die_ref
12818 force_type_die (tree type)
12820 dw_die_ref type_die;
12822 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12823 if (!type_die)
12825 dw_die_ref context_die;
12826 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12828 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12829 context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12830 else
12831 context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12833 else
12834 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12836 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12837 if (type_die)
12838 return type_die;
12839 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12840 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12841 gcc_assert (type_die);
12843 return type_die;
12846 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
12847 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
12849 static dw_die_ref
12850 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
12852 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
12853 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
12854 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
12855 /* Force out the namespace. */
12856 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
12858 return context_die;
12861 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
12862 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
12864 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
12865 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
12867 static void
12868 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
12870 dw_die_ref ns_context;
12872 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12873 return;
12875 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
12876 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
12877 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
12878 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
12879 return;
12881 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
12883 if (ns_context != context_die)
12885 if (DECL_P (thing))
12886 gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
12887 else
12888 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
12892 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
12894 static void
12895 gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
12897 dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
12899 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
12900 they are an alias of. */
12901 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
12903 /* Output a real namespace. */
12904 dw_die_ref namespace_die
12905 = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
12906 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
12907 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
12909 else
12911 /* Output a namespace alias. */
12913 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
12914 dw_die_ref origin_die
12915 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
12917 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
12918 dw_die_ref namespace_die
12919 = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
12920 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
12921 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
12922 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
12926 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
12928 static void
12929 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12931 tree origin;
12933 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
12934 return;
12936 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
12938 case ERROR_MARK:
12939 break;
12941 case CONST_DECL:
12942 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
12943 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
12944 break;
12946 case FUNCTION_DECL:
12947 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
12948 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
12949 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
12950 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
12951 break;
12953 #if 0
12954 /* FIXME */
12955 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
12956 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
12957 if (current_function_decl != decl)
12958 /* This is only a declaration. */;
12959 #endif
12961 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
12962 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
12963 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
12965 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
12966 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
12967 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
12968 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
12969 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
12970 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
12971 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
12972 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
12973 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
12975 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12976 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
12979 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
12980 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12982 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
12983 have described its return type. */
12984 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
12986 /* And its virtual context. */
12987 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
12988 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
12990 /* And its containing type. */
12991 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
12992 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
12993 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
12995 /* And its containing namespace. */
12996 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
12999 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
13000 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13001 break;
13003 case TYPE_DECL:
13004 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13005 actual typedefs. */
13006 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13007 break;
13009 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
13010 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
13011 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
13012 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
13013 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
13014 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
13015 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13017 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13018 break;
13021 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
13022 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13023 else
13024 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
13025 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
13026 break;
13028 case LABEL_DECL:
13029 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
13030 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
13031 break;
13033 case VAR_DECL:
13034 case RESULT_DECL:
13035 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13036 variable declarations or definitions. */
13037 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13038 break;
13040 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
13041 object. */
13042 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13044 /* And its containing type. */
13045 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13046 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13047 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13049 /* And its containing namespace. */
13050 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13052 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
13053 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
13054 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
13055 function. */
13056 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
13057 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
13058 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13059 else
13060 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
13061 break;
13063 case FIELD_DECL:
13064 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
13065 anonymous unions and structs. */
13066 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
13067 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
13068 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
13070 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
13071 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
13073 break;
13075 case PARM_DECL:
13076 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13077 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13078 break;
13080 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13081 gen_namespace_die (decl);
13082 break;
13084 default:
13085 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
13086 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
13087 break;
13091 /* Add Ada "use" clause information for SGI Workshop debugger. */
13093 void
13094 dwarf2out_add_library_unit_info (const char *filename, const char *context_list)
13096 unsigned int file_index;
13098 if (filename != NULL)
13100 dw_die_ref unit_die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13101 tree context_list_decl
13102 = build_decl (LABEL_DECL, get_identifier (context_list),
13103 void_type_node);
13105 TREE_PUBLIC (context_list_decl) = TRUE;
13106 add_name_attribute (unit_die, context_list);
13107 file_index = lookup_filename (filename);
13108 add_AT_unsigned (unit_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
13109 add_pubname (context_list_decl, unit_die);
13113 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
13114 compilation proper has finished. */
13116 static void
13117 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
13119 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
13120 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
13121 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
13122 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
13123 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
13124 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13127 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
13128 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
13129 static void
13130 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
13132 if (!local)
13133 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13136 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl. */
13138 static void
13139 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
13141 dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
13142 dw_die_ref scope_die;
13143 unsigned file_index;
13144 expanded_location xloc;
13146 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13147 return;
13149 gcc_assert (decl);
13151 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
13152 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
13153 itself. */
13155 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
13156 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
13157 if (!context)
13158 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
13159 else if (TYPE_P (context))
13160 scope_die = force_type_die (context);
13161 else
13162 scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
13164 /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE. */
13165 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
13166 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13167 else
13169 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13170 if (!at_import_die)
13172 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
13173 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
13174 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
13176 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13177 dw_die_ref type_context_die;
13179 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13180 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13181 type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13182 else
13183 type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13184 else
13185 type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
13186 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
13188 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
13192 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
13193 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13194 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
13195 else
13196 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
13198 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
13199 file_index = lookup_filename (xloc.file);
13200 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
13201 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
13202 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
13205 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
13207 void
13208 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
13210 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
13212 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13214 case ERROR_MARK:
13215 return;
13217 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13218 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
13219 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
13220 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
13221 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
13222 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
13223 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
13224 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
13225 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
13226 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
13227 with the definition of the function.
13229 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
13230 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
13231 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
13232 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
13233 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
13234 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
13235 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
13236 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
13237 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
13238 that they *are* definitions).
13240 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
13241 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
13242 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
13243 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
13244 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
13245 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
13246 return;
13248 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
13249 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
13250 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
13251 if (decl_function_context (decl)
13252 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
13253 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13254 context_die = NULL;
13255 break;
13257 case VAR_DECL:
13258 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
13259 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
13260 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
13261 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
13262 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
13263 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
13264 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
13265 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
13266 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
13267 return;
13269 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
13270 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
13271 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
13273 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13274 variable declarations or definitions. */
13275 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13276 return;
13277 break;
13279 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13280 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13281 return;
13282 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
13283 return;
13284 break;
13286 case TYPE_DECL:
13287 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
13288 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
13289 return;
13291 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
13292 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
13293 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
13295 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
13296 comparisons have. */
13297 if ((get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
13298 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus)
13299 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
13300 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13301 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
13303 return;
13306 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
13307 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13308 return;
13310 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
13311 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
13312 if (decl_function_context (decl))
13313 context_die = NULL;
13315 break;
13317 default:
13318 return;
13321 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13324 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
13325 a lexical block. */
13327 static void
13328 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13329 unsigned int blocknum)
13331 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13332 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
13335 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
13336 lexical block. */
13338 static void
13339 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
13341 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13342 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
13345 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
13346 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
13348 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
13349 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
13350 we may end up calling them anyway. */
13352 static bool
13353 dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
13355 tree decl;
13357 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13358 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13359 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
13360 return 0;
13362 return 1;
13365 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
13366 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
13367 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
13368 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
13369 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
13370 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
13371 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
13372 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
13373 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
13374 all searches. */
13376 static unsigned
13377 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
13379 size_t i, n;
13380 char *save_file_name;
13382 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
13383 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
13384 if (file_table_last_lookup_index != 0)
13386 const char *last
13387 = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, file_table_last_lookup_index);
13388 if (strcmp (file_name, last) == 0)
13389 return file_table_last_lookup_index;
13392 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
13393 n = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table);
13394 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
13395 if (strcmp (file_name, VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)) == 0)
13397 file_table_last_lookup_index = i;
13398 return i;
13401 /* Add the new entry to the end of the filename table. */
13402 file_table_last_lookup_index = n;
13403 save_file_name = (char *) ggc_strdup (file_name);
13404 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, save_file_name);
13405 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
13407 /* If the assembler is emitting the file table, and we aren't eliminating
13408 unused debug types, then we must emit .file here. If we are eliminating
13409 unused debug types, then this will be done by the maybe_emit_file call in
13410 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs. */
13412 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO && ! flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
13413 return maybe_emit_file (i);
13415 return i;
13418 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
13419 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
13420 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
13421 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
13422 types, which may include filenames. */
13424 static int
13425 maybe_emit_file (int fileno)
13427 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO && fileno > 0)
13429 if (!VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno))
13431 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno) = ++emitcount;
13432 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ",
13433 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno));
13434 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
13435 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, fileno));
13436 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
13438 return VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno);
13440 else
13441 return fileno;
13444 /* Initialize the compiler internal file table. */
13446 static void
13447 init_file_table (void)
13449 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the file_table. */
13450 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR_INIT (file_table, 64, "file_table");
13451 VARRAY_UINT_INIT (file_table_emitted, 64, "file_table_emitted");
13453 /* Skip the first entry - file numbers begin at 1. */
13454 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, NULL);
13455 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
13456 file_table_last_lookup_index = 0;
13459 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
13460 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
13461 our lookup table. */
13463 static void
13464 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
13466 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13467 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
13468 rtx prev_insn;
13469 static rtx last_insn;
13470 static const char *last_label;
13471 tree decl;
13473 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
13474 return;
13475 prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
13477 newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
13478 /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
13479 and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
13480 last time. */
13481 if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
13482 && last_insn == prev_insn
13483 && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
13484 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
13486 newloc->label = last_label;
13488 else
13490 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13491 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13492 loclabel_num++;
13493 newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
13495 newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
13496 newloc->next = NULL;
13498 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13499 newloc->section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
13500 else
13501 newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
13503 last_insn = loc_note;
13504 last_label = newloc->label;
13505 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
13506 if (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (decl) && DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl)
13507 && DECL_P (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl)))
13508 decl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
13509 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
13512 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
13513 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
13514 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
13515 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
13517 static void
13518 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
13520 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
13522 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
13523 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
13526 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
13527 and record information relating to this source line, in
13528 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
13530 static void
13531 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
13533 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
13534 && line != 0)
13536 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13538 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
13539 if (flag_debug_asm)
13540 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
13541 filename, line);
13543 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13545 unsigned file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13547 file_num = maybe_emit_file (file_num);
13549 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
13550 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
13552 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
13553 line_info_table_in_use++;
13555 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
13557 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
13558 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13559 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
13561 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13562 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
13563 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
13565 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13566 separate_line_info_table
13567 = ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
13568 separate_line_info_table_allocated
13569 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
13570 memset (separate_line_info_table
13571 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
13573 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13574 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
13577 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13578 line_info
13579 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
13580 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13581 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13582 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
13584 else
13586 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
13588 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13589 line_info_table_in_use);
13591 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13592 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
13594 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13595 line_info_table
13596 = ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
13597 (line_info_table_allocated
13598 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
13599 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
13600 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13603 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13604 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
13605 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13606 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13611 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
13613 static void
13614 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
13616 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13618 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
13619 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
13621 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13622 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
13625 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13627 int fileno;
13629 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13630 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
13631 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
13632 lineno);
13634 fileno = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13635 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (fileno, "Filename we just started");
13639 /* Record the end of a source file. */
13641 static void
13642 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13644 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13645 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
13646 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13648 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13650 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13651 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
13655 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13656 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13657 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13659 static void
13660 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13661 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13663 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13665 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13666 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
13667 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13668 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13672 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13673 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13674 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13676 static void
13677 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13678 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13680 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13682 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13683 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
13684 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13685 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13689 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
13691 static void
13692 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13694 init_file_table ();
13696 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
13697 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
13698 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
13700 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
13701 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
13702 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
13704 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
13705 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
13707 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
13708 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
13709 * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
13710 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13711 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13712 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
13714 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
13715 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13716 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13717 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13719 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13720 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
13722 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
13723 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
13724 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
13725 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
13726 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
13727 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
13728 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
13730 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
13732 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
13734 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
13735 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13736 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
13737 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13738 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
13739 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13740 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
13741 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13742 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
13743 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13744 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
13745 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13746 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
13747 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13748 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
13749 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
13750 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
13751 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13753 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
13754 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
13755 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13756 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13757 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
13758 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13759 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
13761 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
13762 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13763 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
13764 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13765 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
13766 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13767 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
13768 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
13769 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
13770 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
13771 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
13772 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
13774 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13776 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13777 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
13778 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13779 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
13782 switch_to_section (text_section);
13783 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
13784 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
13786 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
13787 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
13791 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
13792 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
13794 static int
13795 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13797 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
13799 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
13801 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
13802 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
13803 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
13806 return 1;
13811 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
13812 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
13814 static void
13815 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
13817 dw_die_ref c;
13818 die->die_mark = 0;
13819 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
13820 prune_unmark_dies (c);
13824 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
13825 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
13827 static void
13828 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
13830 dw_attr_ref a;
13832 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
13834 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
13836 /* A reference to another DIE.
13837 Make sure that it will get emitted. */
13838 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
13840 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_call_file)
13842 /* A reference to a file. Make sure the file name is emitted. */
13843 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned =
13844 maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
13850 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
13851 to DIE's children. */
13853 static void
13854 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
13856 dw_die_ref c;
13858 if (die->die_mark == 0)
13860 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
13861 die->die_mark = 1;
13863 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
13864 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
13865 if (die->die_parent)
13866 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
13868 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
13869 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
13871 /* If this node is a specification,
13872 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
13873 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
13874 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
13877 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
13879 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
13880 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
13881 die->die_mark = 2;
13883 /* Walk them. */
13884 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
13886 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
13887 kids get marked, even if they're types. */
13888 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
13889 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
13890 else
13891 prune_unused_types_walk (c);
13897 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
13899 static void
13900 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
13902 dw_die_ref c;
13904 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked. */
13905 if (die->die_mark)
13906 return;
13908 switch (die->die_tag) {
13909 case DW_TAG_const_type:
13910 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
13911 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
13912 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
13913 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
13914 case DW_TAG_typedef:
13915 case DW_TAG_array_type:
13916 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
13917 case DW_TAG_union_type:
13918 case DW_TAG_class_type:
13919 case DW_TAG_friend:
13920 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
13921 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
13922 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
13923 case DW_TAG_string_type:
13924 case DW_TAG_set_type:
13925 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
13926 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
13927 case DW_TAG_file_type:
13928 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
13929 return;
13931 default:
13932 /* Mark everything else. */
13933 break;
13936 die->die_mark = 1;
13938 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
13939 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
13941 /* Mark children. */
13942 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
13943 prune_unused_types_walk (c);
13947 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
13949 static void
13950 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
13952 dw_die_ref c, p, n;
13954 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
13956 p = NULL;
13957 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = n)
13959 n = c->die_sib;
13960 if (c->die_mark)
13962 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
13963 p = c;
13965 else
13967 if (p)
13968 p->die_sib = n;
13969 else
13970 die->die_child = n;
13971 free_die (c);
13977 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
13979 static void
13980 prune_unused_types (void)
13982 unsigned int i;
13983 limbo_die_node *node;
13985 /* Clear all the marks. */
13986 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
13987 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
13988 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
13990 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
13991 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
13992 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
13993 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
13995 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
13996 pubname_table or arange_table. */
13997 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
13998 prune_unused_types_mark (pubname_table[i].die, 1);
13999 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
14000 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
14002 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked. */
14003 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
14004 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14005 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
14007 /* Leave the marks clear. */
14008 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
14009 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14010 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
14013 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
14014 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
14016 static void
14017 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
14019 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
14020 dw_die_ref die = 0;
14022 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
14023 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
14024 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
14025 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14026 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14027 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
14029 size_t i;
14030 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
14031 if (VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR
14032 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
14033 && VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != '<')
14035 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14036 break;
14040 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
14041 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
14042 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
14043 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
14044 instance. */
14045 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
14047 next_node = node->next;
14048 die = node->die;
14050 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
14052 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
14054 if (origin)
14055 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
14056 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
14058 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
14059 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
14060 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14061 else
14063 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
14064 nested function can be optimized away, which results
14065 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
14066 with the return type of that nested function. Force
14067 this to be a child of the containing function.
14069 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
14070 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
14071 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
14072 the function is likely unreachable too. */
14073 tree context = NULL_TREE;
14075 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
14077 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
14078 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14079 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
14080 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14082 gcc_assert (context && TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL);
14084 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
14085 if (origin)
14086 add_child_die (origin, die);
14087 else
14088 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14093 limbo_die_list = NULL;
14095 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
14096 emit full debugging info for them. */
14097 retry_incomplete_types ();
14099 /* We need to reverse all the dies before break_out_includes, or
14100 we'll see the end of an include file before the beginning. */
14101 reverse_all_dies (comp_unit_die);
14103 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
14104 prune_unused_types ();
14106 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
14107 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
14108 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14109 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
14111 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
14112 that have children. */
14113 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
14114 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14115 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
14117 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
14118 switch_to_section (text_section);
14119 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14120 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14122 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14123 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14126 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
14127 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
14128 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
14129 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
14130 examining the file. */
14131 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14133 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14134 output_line_info ();
14137 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
14138 in .text. */
14139 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
14141 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
14142 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
14145 /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
14146 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
14147 else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
14148 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
14150 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
14151 if (have_location_lists)
14153 /* Output the location lists info. */
14154 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
14155 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
14156 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14157 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
14158 output_location_lists (die);
14161 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
14162 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
14163 debug_line_section_label);
14165 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14166 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
14168 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
14169 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
14170 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14171 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
14173 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
14175 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
14176 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14177 output_abbrev_section ();
14179 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
14180 if (pubname_table_in_use)
14182 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
14183 output_pubnames ();
14186 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
14187 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
14188 if (fde_table_in_use)
14190 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
14191 output_aranges ();
14194 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
14195 if (ranges_table_in_use)
14197 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
14198 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
14199 output_ranges ();
14202 /* Have to end the macro section. */
14203 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14205 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14206 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
14209 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
14210 table too. */
14211 if (debug_str_hash)
14212 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
14214 #else
14216 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
14217 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
14219 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
14221 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"